Systemhandbuch SIMOCODE Pro en-US
Systemhandbuch SIMOCODE Pro en-US
Systemhandbuch SIMOCODE Pro en-US
Advantages/benefits/
configuration with 2
SIMOCODE pro
Compartment identification 9
Accessories 10
Technical specifications 15
CAx data, dimension
drawings 16
10/2022
A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
List of abbreviations 17
Legal information
Warning notice system
This manual contains notices you have to observe in order to ensure your personal safety, as well as to prevent damage
to property. The notices referring to your personal safety are highlighted in the manual by a safety alert symbol, notices
referring only to property damage have no safety alert symbol. These notices shown below are graded according to
the degree of danger.
DANGER
indicates that death or severe personal injury will result if proper precautions are not taken.
WARNING
indicates that death or severe personal injury may result if proper precautions are not taken.
CAUTION
indicates that minor personal injury can result if proper precautions are not taken.
NOTICE
indicates that property damage can result if proper precautions are not taken.
If more than one degree of danger is present, the warning notice representing the highest degree of danger will be
used. A notice warning of injury to persons with a safety alert symbol may also include a warning relating to property
damage.
Qualified Personnel
The product/system described in this documentation may be operated only by personnel qualified for the specific
task in accordance with the relevant documentation, in particular its warning notices and safety instructions.
Qualified personnel are those who, based on their training and experience, are capable of identifying risks and
avoiding potential hazards when working with these products/systems.
Proper use of Siemens products
Note the following:
WARNING
Siemens products may only be used for the applications described in the catalog and in the relevant technical
documentation. If products and components from other manufacturers are used, these must be recommended or
approved by Siemens. Proper transport, storage, installation, assembly, commissioning, operation and maintenance
are required to ensure that the products operate safely and without any problems. The permissible ambient
conditions must be complied with. The information in the relevant documentation must be observed.
Trademarks
All names identified by ® are registered trademarks of Siemens AG. The remaining trademarks in this publication may
be trademarks whose use by third parties for their own purposes could violate the rights of the owner.
Disclaimer of Liability
We have reviewed the contents of this publication to ensure consistency with the hardware and software described.
Since variance cannot be precluded entirely, we cannot guarantee full consistency. However, the information in this
publication is reviewed regularly and any necessary corrections are included in subsequent editions.
1 Introduction ........................................................................................................................................... 9
1.1 What is SIMOCODE pro? ....................................................................................................... 9
1.2 Important notes................................................................................................................... 9
1.3 Siemens Industry Online Support ....................................................................................... 12
1.4 Siemens Industry Online Support app................................................................................. 13
1.5 Support Request ................................................................................................................ 13
1.6 Security information .......................................................................................................... 14
1.7 Current information about operational safety ..................................................................... 14
1.8 Information for SIMOCODE pro regarding IEC60947-4-1:2018 ............................................ 15
1.8.1 Line system configurations ................................................................................................. 15
1.8.2 Protection of inputs and outputs ........................................................................................ 15
1.8.3 Touch current .................................................................................................................... 15
1.9 Information about third-party software .............................................................................. 16
1.10 Recycling and disposal ....................................................................................................... 19
1.11 Device series...................................................................................................................... 20
1.12 Modules, interfaces, configuration options ......................................................................... 22
2 Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro .................................................................... 25
2.1 Advantages/benefits........................................................................................................... 25
2.2 Independent operation ...................................................................................................... 27
2.3 Simplifying configuration with SIMOCODE pro .................................................................... 28
2.4 Typical configuration.......................................................................................................... 30
3 Areas of application............................................................................................................................. 33
4 Features ............................................................................................................................................... 35
5 Overview of functions ......................................................................................................................... 39
5.1 Protection functions........................................................................................................... 39
5.2 Monitoring functions ......................................................................................................... 40
5.3 Safety-oriented tripping ..................................................................................................... 43
5.4 Control functions ............................................................................................................... 44
5.5 Communication ................................................................................................................. 45
5.6 Analog value recording ...................................................................................................... 47
5.7 Standard functions............................................................................................................. 48
5.8 Freely-programmable logic modules................................................................................... 48
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 3
Table of contents
SIMOCODE pro
4 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Table of contents
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 5
Table of contents
SIMOCODE pro
6 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Table of contents
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 7
Table of contents
SIMOCODE pro
8 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction 1
1.1 What is SIMOCODE pro?
SIMOCODE pro (SIRIUS Motor Management and Control Device) is a flexible motor management
system for motors with constant speeds in low-voltage applications.
SIMOCODE pro optimizes the link between the control system and the motor feeder, increases
plant availability and allows significant savings to be made during installation, commissioning,
operation and maintenance.
SIMOCODE pro is installed in the motor control center or in the low-voltage switchgear system
and links the higher-level automation system and the motor feeder intelligently. It comprises the
following functions:
• Multifunctional and electronic full motor protection, independently of the automation
system
• Integrated control functions for motor control instead of hardware
• Detailed operational data, service data, and diagnostic data
• Fail-safe shutdown up to SIL3
• Open communication through PROFINET, Modbus TCP, and EtherNet/IP
• Parameterization with the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) software package
Only the switching and short-circuit protection mechanisms of the main circuit (contactors,
circuit breakers, fuses) are additionally needed.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 9
Introduction
1.2 Important notes
Manual Collection
A Manual Collection (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743951), a
collection of the following five SIMOCODE pro manuals, is available in Industry Online Support:
• SIMOCODE pro - 1 Getting Started
• SIMOCODE pro - 2 System Manual
• SIMOCODE pro - 3 Parameterization
• SIMOCODE pro - 4 Applications
• SIMOCODE pro - 5 Communication.
SIMOCODE pro
10 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.2 Important notes
More information
You can find more information on the internet at:
• SIMOCODE pro (https://www.siemens.com/simocode)
• Information and Download Center (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/
16027/cat)
• Siemens Industry Online Support (SIOS) (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/
ps)
• Certificates (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/cert).
Disclaimer of liability
The products described have been developed to implement safety-related functions as part of a
complete plant or machine. In general, a complete safety system consists of sensors, evaluation
units, signaling devices and methods for safe tripping. The manufacturer is responsible for
ensuring safe functioning of the complete plant or machine. Siemens AG, its subsidiaries, and
associated companies (hereinafter referred to as "Siemens") are not in a position to guarantee
every characteristic of a complete plant or machine not designed by Siemens.
Nor can Siemens assume liability for recommendations that appear or are implied in the
following description. No new guarantee, warranty, or liability claims beyond the scope of the
Siemens general terms of supply are to be derived or inferred with regard to the following
description.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 11
Introduction
1.3 Siemens Industry Online Support
Product support
You can find information and comprehensive know-how covering all aspects of your product
here:
• FAQs
Answers to frequently asked questions
• Manuals/operating instructions
Read online or download, available as PDF or individually configurable.
• Certificates
Clearly sorted according to approving authority, type and country.
• Characteristics
For support in planning and configuring your system.
• Product announcements
The latest information and news concerning our products.
• Downloads
Here you will find updates, service packs, HSPs and much more for your product.
• Application examples
Function blocks, background and system descriptions, performance statements,
demonstration systems, and application examples, clearly explained and represented.
• Technical data
Technical product data for support in planning and implementing your project
Link: Product support (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps)
mySupport
The following functions are available in your personal work area "mySupport":
• Support Request
Search for request number, product or subject
• My filters
With filters, you limit the content of the online support to different focal points.
SIMOCODE pro
12 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.5 Support Request
• My favorites
With favorites you bookmark articles and products that you need frequently.
• My notifications
Your personal mailbox for exchanging information and managing your contacts. You can
compile your own individual newsletter in the "Notifications" section.
• My products
With product lists you can virtually map your control cabinet, your system or your entire
automation project.
• My documentation
Configure your individual documentation from different manuals.
• CAx data
Easy access to CAx data, e.g. 3D models, 2D dimension drawings, EPLAN macros, device
circuit diagrams
• My IBase registrations
Register your Siemens products, systems and software.
Android iOS
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 13
Introduction
1.7 Current information about operational safety
DANGER
Hazardous Voltage
Can Cause Death, Serious Injury or Risk of Property Damage
Please take note of our latest information!
Systems with safety-related characteristics are subject to special operational safety
requirements on the part of the operator. The supplier is also obliged to comply with special
product monitoring measures. We therefore also provide information in the newsletters
Industrial controls (https://new.siemens.com/global/en/products/automation/industrial-
controls/forms/newsletter.html) and Safety Integrated (https://new.siemens.com/global/en/
products/automation/topic-areas/safety-integrated/factory-automation/newsletter.html)
about new products, further technical developments as well as standards and guidelines.
SIMOCODE pro
14 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.8 Information for SIMOCODE pro regarding IEC60947-4-1:2018
[V] [V]
-- 230
230 / 400 400
260 / 440 440
-- 500
400 / 690 600
The nameplates of the current/voltage measuring modules state a maximum line voltage of
400/690 V.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 15
Introduction
1.9 Information about third-party software
DANGER
Hazardous touch current
When connecting multiple SIMOCODE systems in parallel, make sure that no hazardous touch
current occurs.
The SIMOCODE basic units in the 110-240 V AC/DC version include galvanic isolation. This avoids
the effect of parallel connection via a central supply voltage for multiple systems when these
basic units are used.
The SIMOCODE basic units in the 24 V DC version do not include galvanic isolation.
NOTICE
PELV power supply required
When using numerous current/voltage measuring modules with these basic devices, deploy a
PELV power supply, for example, to prevent a potential touch current.
NOTICE
Ground leakage current
Pay attention to any resulting ground leakage current that may occur.
SIMOCODE pro
16 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.9 Information about third-party software
the LGPL-licensed module is combined are hereinafter referred to as "combined product") and
the applicable LGPL license criteria are fulfilled, you may additionally (i) edit the combined
product for your own purposes and may in particular acquire the right to edit the combined
product to link it with a modified version of the LGPL-licensed module and (ii) reverse engineer
the combined product, but solely for the purpose of error correction of your edits. The right to
edit shall not include the right to distribute. You must treat as confidential all information you
acquire from reverse engineering of the combined product.
Certain OSS licenses require SIEMENS to publish the source code, e.g. the
GNU General Public License, the GNU Lesser General Public License and the
Mozilla Public License. Insofar as these licenses apply and the product has not already been
delivered with the necessary source code, anyone may request a copy of the source code from
Support Request during the period of time specified in the applicable OSS license:
Use the Support Request online form to send your query directly to our Technical Support. After
describing your query in a few guided steps, you will immediately be provided with possible
suggestions for solving the problem.
Subject: open source inquiry (specify the product name and version, where applicable)
NOTICE
Open source software and/or third-party software included in this product
Please note the following license terms and conditions and copyright notices applicable to the
open source software and/or other components (or parts thereof):
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 17
Introduction
1.9 Information about third-party software
License conditions:
//
// Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
// modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
// are met:
//
// Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
// notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
//
// Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
// notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
// documentation and/or other materials provided with the
// distribution.
//
// Neither the name of Texas Instruments Incorporated nor the names of
// its contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
// from this software without specific prior written permission.
//
// THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
// "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
// LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR
// A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT
// OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
// SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
// LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,
// DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
// THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
// (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE
// OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
SIMOCODE pro
18 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.11 Device series
Copyrights:
Copyright © 2013-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2012-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2011-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2010-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2008-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2007-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2006-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
Copyright © 2005-2014 Texas Instruments Incorporated
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 19
Introduction
1.11 Device series
SIMOCODE pro
20 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
SIMOCODE pro
PROFINET IO / OPC UA ETHERNET / IP PROFIBUS MODBUS RTU
Figure 1-1
Current/voltage measuring module
Safety
SIMOCODE pro V PN SIMOCODE pro V EIP SIMOCODE pro V PB SIMOCODE pro V MR
Operator panel
General
1 expansion module
Performance
21
1.11 Device series
Introduction
Introduction
1.12 Modules, interfaces, configuration options
NOTICE
Maximum length of the connecting cable
The total length of all cables must not exceed 3 m on either of the system interfaces of the basic
unit!
NOTICE
The maximum distance between modules
The maximum distance between the modules (e. g. between the basic unit and the current
measuring module) must not exceed 2.5 m.
Additional control programs (star-delta starters, Dahlander starters, pole-changing starters, soft
starters, each program also possible in combination with reversing starter, solenoid valve and
positioner) are integrated in SIMOCODE pro V High Performance units. The SIMOCODE pro V
device type is also particularly versatile. Its functionality can be expanded, if required, for
example:
• The number and type of binary inputs and outputs can be increased in stages and adapted.
• A current/voltage measuring module can be used for additional voltage measurement and
for monitoring power-related measured values (power management).
• A temperature module enables the evaluation of several analog temperature sensors.
• A ground-fault detection system can be integrated together with a residual-current
transformer.
• An analog module extends the system by additional analog inputs and outputs, for example,
for fill-level or flow-rate monitoring.
• An operator panel with display (OPD) is available as an alternative to the standard operator
panel (OP) (restriction in the case of the SIMOCODE pro V PB: from version *E03*).
SIMOCODE pro
22 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Introduction
1.12 Modules, interfaces, configuration options
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 23
Introduction
1.12 Modules, interfaces, configuration options
SIMOCODE pro
24 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Advantages/bene its/con iguration with
SIMOCODE pro 2
2.1 Advantages/benefits
• The quantity of cabling required between the motor feeder and the PLC is reduced
significantly by connecting the entire motor feeder to the process control system via the
fieldbus (see Figures "SIMOCODE pro, integrated in the main circuit, control circuit and at
automation level (PLC)")
• Automated processes are decentralized by means of configurable control and monitoring
functions in the feeder. This saves automation system resources and ensures that the feeder
is fully functional and protected even if the control system or bus system fails.
• By recording and monitoring operating, service and diagnostics data in the feeder and
process control system, plant availability is increased, and the feeder is easier to service and
maintain.
• The user can implement plant-specific requirements for every motor feeder thanks to the
high degree of modularity.
• SIMOCODE pro provides compact solutions and different levels of functions for every
customer application.
• By replacing the control circuit hardware with an integrated control function, the quantity of
required hardware components with wiring is reduced. This drives down storage costs and
limits potential wiring errors.
• Using electronic full motor protection allows the motors to be used more efficiently and
ensures that the tripping characteristic remains stable and the tripping response stays the
same, even after many years.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 25
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.1 Advantages/benefits
4
. .
2SHUDWRUSDQHO
&XUUHQWPHDVXULQJPRGXOH
&RQQHFWLQJFDEOH
%DVLFXQLWVSUR&9
. .
5HPRWH
Figure 2-1 SIMOCODE pro C, pro V, integrated in the main circuit, control circuit and at automation level (PLC)
SIMOCODE pro
26 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.2 Independent operation
4
. .
&XUUHQWPHDVXULQJPRGXOH
2SHUDWRUSDQHO
&RQQHFWLQJFDEOH
%DVLFXQLWSUR6
. .
5HPRWH
Figure 2-2 SIMOCODE pro S, integrated in the main circuit, control circuit and at automation level (PLC)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 27
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.3 Simplifying configuration with SIMOCODE pro
13(a+]9 /
/ )
/
/
1 $XWRPDWLRQ OHYHO ,2 PRGXOH
3(
4
)HHGEDFN &RQWURO FRPPDQGV
)
7KHUPLVWRU
4 RSHQ
2YHUORDG
DXWRPDWLF
212))
4
&XUUHQW
0DQXDO
2))
21
)
;
4
4
0DQXDO $XWR
;
/RFDO VWRS
)
6 3/&
6WDUWVWRS
/RFDO VWDUW
4
6 4
$P$
3( 8 9 :
4 4
0 ˽ 4 4 ) ) 4 '
a ; ) $
1
4 7KHUPLVWRU
6ZLWFKJHDU
HYDOXDWLRQ
1
SIMOCODE pro
28 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.3 Simplifying configuration with SIMOCODE pro
• The start and stop switches are wired directly to the inputs of the basic unit.
• The contactor coil is energized via the output of the basic unit. An auxiliary contact for
locking is not required.
The following figure illustrates a configuration with SIMOCODE pro connected to PROFIBUS:
4 &RQWURO VWDWLRQ
)
/RFDO FRQWURO VWDWLRQ >/&@
6 6
/LTXLG FRQWDLQHU
'LVSOD\
4
1/ದ 0RWRU FXUUHQW
4
8QLW RI , V
3XPS
3( 2SWLRQDO
8 9 :
3&ZLWK
7
0 7KHUPLVWRU 6,02&2'( (6
˽
a
7
Figure 2-4 Configuration of a load feeder (direct-on-line starter) with SIMOCODE pro
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 29
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.4 Typical configuration
&XUUHQW PHDVXULQJ
PRGXOH,0
2SHUDWRU SDQHO 23
8)
Figure 2-5 Typical SIMOCODE pro C hardware configuration
6,02&2'( SUR 6
%DVLF 8QLW %8
0XOWLIXQFWLRQPRGXOH00
&XUUHQW PHDVXULQJ
PRGXOH,0
2SHUDWRU 3DQHO 23
SIMOCODE pro
30 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.4 Typical configuration
&XUUHQWPHDVXULQJ
PRGXOH,0
2SHUDWRU SDQHO 23
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 31
Advantages/benefits/configuration with SIMOCODE pro
2.4 Typical configuration
&XUUHQWPHDVXULQJ
PRGXOH,0
2SHUDWRU SDQHO 23
For information about system components, see Chapter Description of system components
(Page 73).
SIMOCODE pro
32 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Areas of application 3
SIMOCODE pro is often used for automated processes where plant downtimes are very
expensive (e.g. steel or cement industry) and where it is important to prevent plant downtimes
through detailed operating, service and diagnostics data or to localize the fault very quickly in
the event of a fault.
SIMOCODE pro is modular and space-saving and suited especially for operation in motor control
centers (MCC) in the process industry and in power plants.
Applications:
• Protection and control of motors:
– in hazardous areas for different types of protection according to the ATEX
Directive 2014/34/EU (see also Section Safety and commissioning information for Ex
areas (Page 279))
– in hazardous areas in accordance with the Equipment and Protective Systems Intended
for Use in Potentially Explosive Atmospheres Regulations 2016 (S.I. 2016:1107), and
associated amendments
– Heavy-starting motors (paper, cement and metal industries; water management)
– In high-availability plants (chemical, oil, and raw material processing industry, power
plants)
• Dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring of motors and
shutdown if power consumption falls below a minimum value – especially also including
hazardous areas
– Type of ignition protection b "Control of ignition sources", ignition protection system b1,
approval according to DIN EN ISO 80079-37
– Approval according to ATEX Directive 2014/34/EU and IEC Ex
– Approval in accordance with the Equipment and Protective Systems Intended for Use in
Potentially Explosive Atmospheres Regulations 2016 (S.I. 2016:1107), and associated
amendments
See also Chapter Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
(Page 289) in the safety and commissioning information for Ex areas.
SIMOCODE pro is especially designed for the chemical industry (including oil and gas), the steel
industry, water management, and the paper, pharmaceutical, cement and glass industries.
Further applications include power plant engineering and diamond, gold and platinum mines.
Based on the experience gained with the predecessor system SIMOCODE DP, SIMOCODE pro has
been tailored even more specifically to the requirements of these industries. The availability of
motors and thus the entire process plays an important role in these industries. Downtimes
caused by faults often lead to high costs. This is why it is even more important to detect potential
faults early on and to initiate targeted, preventative measures. SIMOCODE pro provides the user
with a motor management system based on years of experience and the latest technology.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 33
Areas of application
SIMOCODE pro
34 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Features 4
Multifunction, electronic full motor protection for rated motor currents up to 820 A
SIMOCODE pro provides comprehensive protection of the motor feeder by means of a
combination of delayable, multi-level protection and monitoring functions:
• Current-dependent delayed electronic overload protection (CLASS 5E to 40E)
• Thermistor motor protection
• Phase failure/unbalance protection
• Stalled rotor protection
• Monitoring of adjustable limit values for the motor current
• Voltage monitoring
• Active power monitoring
• Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by means of active power monitoring
• Monitoring of cos phi (no-load operation/load shedding)
• Ground-fault monitoring
• Temperature monitoring, e.g. using Pt100/Pt1000
• Monitoring of operating hours
• Monitoring of downtimes
• Monitoring the number of starts within a specific period of time
• Safety-related tripping of motor feeders, e.g. fail-safe tripping in the process industry, locally
or via fieldbus (see manual "SIMOCODE pro Safety fail-safe digital modules" (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852))
Flexible motor control with integrated control functions (instead of extensive hardware
interlocks):
SIMOCODE pro has many pre-defined, integrated motor control functions, including all
necessary connections and interlocks:
• Overload relay
• Direct starter (direct-on-line starter)
• Reversing starter
• Star-delta starter, also with direction reversal
• Two speeds, motors with separate windings (pole-changing starter), also with direction of
rotation reversal
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 35
Features
• Two speeds, motors with separate Dahlander windings, also with direction of rotation
reversal
• Positioner control
• Solenoid valve control
• Actuation of a circuit breaker
• Soft starter control, possibly combined with reversing starter
These control functions are pre-defined in SIMOCODE pro and can be assigned freely to device
inputs and outputs.
These pre-defined control functions can also be adjusted flexibly to meet customer requirements
of the motor feeder, without requiring additional auxiliary relays in the control circuit. This is
achieved by means of freely parameterizable logic modules (truth tables, counters, timers, pulse
width modulators, etc.) and standard functions (power failure monitoring, emergency start,
external fault monitoring, etc.).
Communication:
The SIMOCODE pro basic units have integrated communication bus interfaces and are thus able
to replaces all individual wiring and distribution boxes normally required to exchange data with
a higher-level automation system with a single bus cable.
SIMOCODE pro
36 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Features
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 37
Features
sends a request to a slave address and only this slave address responds to the command
(exception: broadcast frames to slave address 0 that are not acknowledged by the slaves).
SIMOCODE pro V Modbus devices have been developed in accordance with the "MODBUS over
serial line specification and implementation guide" (available at www.modbus.org (http://
www.modbus.org)). You can find the relevant information on establishing Modbus RTU
communication in this specification. The key points for a Modbus RTU communication network
("Multipoint System requirements") listed in the specification apply equally for a communication
network with SIMOCODE devices.
See Chapter "Modbus communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro - Communication (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
SIMOCODE pro
38 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions 5
5.1 Protection functions
Detailed description: See Chapter "Motor protection" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE
pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958).
Overload protection
Current-dependent electronic protection of three-phase and AC motors with adjustable tripping
characteristics (class times) according to IEC 60947‑4‑1 requirements.
Unbalance protection
Protects motors from excessive temperatures caused by excessive phase unbalance.
Thermistor protection
SIMOCODE pro provides the option of connecting thermistor sensors (binary PTC) for
monitoring the motor temperature.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 39
Overview of functions
5.2 Monitoring functions
This applies to centrifugal pumps with progressive flow characteristics, which are also suitable
for pumping flammable media and are also installed in hazardous areas.
WARNING
Installation in potentially explosive atmospheres
SIMOCODE pro itself is not suitable for installation in potentially explosive atmospheres!
If the active power, and thus the flow rate, falls below a minimum value, the motor - and thus
the centrifugal pump - is switched off The devices support monitoring of the minimum flow rate
for a freely selectable minimum value. A delay time (effective during operation including the
pump's regular switch-off) can be specified to minimize the probability of incorrect tripping in
addition to the parameter for the trip level of the minimum active power (which corresponds to
a minimum flow rate). During the start-up procedure, operation with active power below the
trip level can constitute a regular operating status of short duration (depending on the
procedure used to open the pressure-side shut-off valve). For this reason, a start-up bridging
time can be specified to prevent incorrect tripping during the start-up procedure.
The parameters can be entered using the "SIMOCODE ES" (TIA Portal) engineering software.
It is also possible to determine the trip level in a "teach-in" and to enter the further parameters
with the aid of menu-guided input screens. Using this method, the operating point with
optimum flow rate and the point with minimum flow rate are started up with real operating
medium, as a result of which the trip level of the minimum active power is determined. The
teach-in has to be repeated following any changes in the pump or system characteristics (e.g. as
a result of changing the operating medium or of intervention in the plant configuration).
With regard to dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps, a current/voltage measuring
module especially intended for this function is also required in addition to the basic unit.
See also:
• Chapter "Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
(Page 289)" in the safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
• Chapter "Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps" in the manual Parameterizing
SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958).
SIMOCODE pro
40 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.2 Monitoring functions
Ground-fault monitoring
Residual current monitoring relays are used in industry to
• Protect systems from damage caused by residual currents
• Prevent production losses caused by unplanned downtime
• Perform maintenance to meet all demands.
Basic units have:
• An internal ground-fault monitoring system: For motors with a 3-wire connection, the basic
unit calculates a possible fault current/ground-fault current from the total current via a
current measuring module or a current / voltage measuring module. Internal ground-fault
monitoring is only possible for motors with a 3-phase connection in networks that are either
grounded directly or grounded with low impedance.
• External ground-fault monitoring in SIMOCODE pro S and SIMOCODE pro V 4) : The external
ground-fault monitoring using residual current transformer 3UL23 and ground-fault module
is normally used in the following cases:
– in cases in which power systems are grounded with high impedance
– in cases, in which precise detection of the ground-fault current is necessary, for example,
for condition monitoring.
A ground-fault module can be used to create an additional input on the SIMOCODE pro V and
SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic units to connect a 3UL23 residual current transformer.
A multifunction module can be used to create an additional input on the SIMOCODE pro S
basic unit to connect a 3UL23 residual current transformer.
With ground-fault detection using the 3UL23 residual current transformer, it is possible to
determine the precise residual current as a measured value, and to define freely selectable
warning and trip limits in a wide range from 30 mA - 40 A.
See also Chapter "External ground-fault monitoring with 3UL23 residual current transformer"
in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/
en/view/109743958).
Voltage monitoring 1)
High Performance SIMOCODE pro V allows voltage monitoring of a three-phase current network
or a single-phase network for undervoltage or further availability:
• Monitoring for undervoltage: Two-level monitoring for freely selectable limits. The response
of SIMOCODE pro on reaching a prewarning level or trip level can be freely parameterized.
• Monitoring for further availability: Even when the motor is switched off, SIMOCODE pro can
indicate the further availability of the feeder by measuring the voltage directly at the circuit
breaker or fuses.
Temperature monitoring 2)
The SIMOCODE pro S, SIMOCODE pro V and SIMOCODE pro V PN GP devices offer the option of
implementing analog temperature monitoring, e.g. of the motor windings or the bearings -
SIMOCODE pro S with the multifunction module, SIMOCODE pro V/SIMOCODE pro V PN with the
temperature module.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 41
Overview of functions
5.2 Monitoring functions
SIMOCODE pro S and SIMOCODE pro V support two-level monitoring for overtemperature for
freely selectable limit values. The response of SIMOCODE pro on reaching a prewarning level or
trip level can be freely parameterized and delayed. Temperature monitoring takes into account
the highest temperature of all the sensor measuring circuits in use.
SIMOCODE pro
42 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.3 Safety-oriented tripping
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 43
Overview of functions
5.4 Control functions
You will find the System Manuals and Operating Instructions at Manuals/operating instructions
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man)
CAUTION
Loss of safety function is possible
For the 24 V DC power supply, always use an SELV or PELV power supply unit!
For capacitive and inductive loads, an adequate protective circuit is required!
SIMOCODE pro
44 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.5 Communication
All the necessary protection functions and interlocks are already available and can be flexibly
adapted and expanded.
For a detailed description of the individual control functions: See Chapter "Motor control" in the
manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743958).
5.5 Communication
PROFIBUS DP
SIMOCODE pro has an integrated PROFIBUS DP interface (SUB D socket or terminal connection
on the basic units). SIMOCODE pro supports the following services, for example:
Detailed description: See Chapter "PROFIBUS DP communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro
- Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
Modbus RTU
SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU possesses integrated Modbus RTU communication functions.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 45
Overview of functions
5.5 Communication
Detailed description: See Chapter "Modbus communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro -
Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
PROFINET
PROFINET IO
SIMOCODE pro V PN and pro V PN GP have integrated PROFINET IO device communication
functions, such as:
• Integrated switch with two RJ45 ports
• Ethernet services: ping, arp, network diagnostics (SNMP) / BIB-2, LLDP, NTP
• Port diagnostics
• Deactivation of ports
• Media redundancy
• Shared device
• Device replacement without PG/PC
• I/O data
• Diagnostics and maintenance alarms
• Data records
• PROFIenergy
• PROFIsafe
Note
Use of PORT connections with SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic units
Only PORT 1 can be used with SIMOCODE pro V PN GP 3UF7011-1A.00-2 basic units
OPC UA
In addition to the PROFINET IO device communication functions, SIMOCODE pro V PN also has
OPC UA server functions. Using these functions, an OPC UA client can access SIMOCODE pro V PN
data.
Web server
In addition to the PROFINET IO device communication functions, both the SIMOCODE pro V PN
High Performance device and the SIMOCODE pro V PN General Performance device have an
integrated web server function that permits access to the service and diagnostic data from a PC
on which a web browser is installed.
Detailed descriptions: See Chapter "PROFINET communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro -
Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
SIMOCODE pro
46 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.6 Analog value recording
EtherNet/IP
SIMOCODE pro V EtherNet/IP has integrated EtherNet/IP communication functions:
• Integrated switch with two RJ45 ports
• Assembly objects for integration in cyclic communication with the controller
• CIP objects
• Application objects for access to SIMOCODE data such as measured values, statistics data,
diagnostics and selected parameters
• Device Level Ring support
• Ethernet services: ping, arp, network diagnostics (SNMP)/BIB-2, LLDP, NTP
• Port diagnostics
• Deactivation of ports
Detailed description: See Chapter "EtherNet/IP communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro -
Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
Web server
In addition to the EtherNet/IP communication functions, SIMOCODE pro V EIP has an integrated
web server function that permits access to the service and diagnostic data from a PC on which
a web browser is installed.
Detailed descriptions: See Chapter "EtherNet/IP communication" in the manual SIMOCODE pro
- Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743960)"SIMOCODE pro - Communication".
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 47
Overview of functions
5.8 Freely-programmable logic modules
Detailed description: See Chapter "Standard functions" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE
pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958).
SIMOCODE pro
48 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.9 Operating, service and diagnostics data
Detailed description: See Chapter "Logic blocks" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958).
Operating data
• Motor switching state (ON, OFF, LEFT, RIGHT, SLOW, FAST), derived from the current flow in
the main circuit: thus, feedback via auxiliary contacts of circuit breakers and contactors is not
necessary.
• Current in phases 1, 2 and 3 and maximum current in % of current setting
• Voltage in phases 1, 2 and 3 in V 1)
• Frequency 7)
• Active power in W 1)
• Apparent power in VA 1)
• Power factor in % 1)
• Phase unbalance in %
• Phase sequence 1)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 49
Overview of functions
5.9 Operating, service and diagnostics data
• Ground-fault current 6)
• Temperature in the respective sensor measuring circuits, and maximum temperature in K 3)
• Current analog signal values 4)
• Time to trip in s
• Temperature rise for motor model in %
• Remaining cooling down period of the motor in s, etc.
It is possible to adapt the units via the device-internal conversion of individual measured values
with the help of the logic modules (calculators) provided by SIMOCODE pro. For example, the
temperature recorded by SIMOCODE pro can be calculated in either °F or °C and transmitted to
the automation system via PROFIBUS DP.
Service data
Among other things, SIMOCODE pro provides the following relevant data for maintenance:
• Number of motor operating hours, also resettable
• Motor stop times, also resettable
• Number of motor starts, also resettable
• Number of permissible starts remaining
• Number of overload trips, also resettable
• Feeder power consumption in kWh, also resettable 2)
• Internal feeder-related comments stored in the device, e.g. information regarding
maintenance events, etc.
• Safety-related tripping monitoring in h, also resettable 5)
Diagnostics data
• Numerous detailed early warning and fault messages, also for further processing in the
device or in the control system
• Device-internal error logging with time stamp
• Value of the last trip current
• Feedback faults (e.g. no current flow in the main circuit after switch-on command), etc.
• "Local" and "PROFIsafe" diagnostic messages
1) When using SIMOCODE pro V High Performance basic units with current / voltage measuring
module
2) When using SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units from version *E03* current / voltage measuring
module
3) When using the SIMOCODE pro V basic units with the 3UF77 temperature module or the
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit with multifunction module
4) When using SIMOCODE pro V High Performance basic units with analog module
SIMOCODE pro
50 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Overview of functions
5.9 Operating, service and diagnostics data
5) When using SIMOCODE pro V High Performance basic units together with DM-F fail-safe
digital module
6) When using the SIMOCODE pro V basic units with the 3UF7510 ground-fault module or the
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit with a multifunction module and 3UL23 residual current transformer
7) 2nd generation current / voltage measuring module necessary
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 51
Overview of functions
5.9 Operating, service and diagnostics data
SIMOCODE pro
52 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Check list for selecting a device series 6
The following check list should help you decide upon the optimum device series for your
requirements:
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 53
Check list for selecting a device series
SIMOCODE pro
54 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Check list for selecting a device series
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 55
Check list for selecting a device series
SIMOCODE pro
56 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components 7
Modules
Selection and ordering data: See also Catalog IC10 (https://www.siemens.com/ic10).
For simple product selection, we recommend the TIA Selection Tool (https://www.siemens.com/
TIA-Selection-Tool).
Note
Product version data
The product version data (*Exx*) refer to the device series (pro C, pro S, etc.).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 57
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
58 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 59
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
60 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 61
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
62 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 63
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
64 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 65
An overview of system components
1)
Note
When using the 2nd generation current / voltage acquisition modules (UM+), no decoupling
module must be connected.
Note
Use of a DM-F instead of a DM
You use a fail-safe digital module (DM-FL or DM-FP) instead of a digital module (DM).
SIMOCODE pro
66 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
4)
Note
Usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display
• SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit: You only use the operator panel with display with SIMOCODE
pro V PB basic unit from version *E03*.
• SIMOCODE pro V PN, pro V EIP basic unit: An operator panel with display from version *E07*
is required for use with these basic units.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro PN basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro MR basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• When using the "Dry-running protection by means of active power monitoring" function, the
following operator panels with display are permitted:
– 3UF7210-1AA00-0: ≥ E12
– 3UF7210-1AA01-0: ≥ E03
– 3UF7210-1BA00-0: ≥ E04
– 3UF7210-1BA01-0: ≥ E03
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 67
An overview of system components
Accessories
Selection and ordering data: See also Catalog IC10 (https://www.siemens.com/ic10).
System component, acces‐ MLFB Diagram for for for V PN for pro for for for
sory pro C pro S GP V PB pro V pro V P pro V E
MB RT N IP
U
Connecting cable ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
for connecting the basic unit, current measur‐
ing module, current/voltage measuring mod‐
ule, operator panel, and decoupling module
0.025 m ribbon 3UF7930-0AA0
0.1 m ribbon 0-0
0.15 m ribbon 3UF7931-0AA0
0-0
0.3 m ribbon
3UF7935-0AA0
0.5 m ribbon
0-0
0.5 m round
3UF7932-0AA0
1.0 m round 0-0
1.5 m round 3UF7932-0BA0
2.5 m round 0-0
3UF7937-0BA0
0-0
.........
3UF7933-0BA0
0-0
Interface covers 3UF7950-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
For covering unused system 0-0 (light gray)
interfaces 3RA6936-0B (ti‐
tanium gray)
Memory module 3UF7900-0AA0 ✓ ✓ — ✓ ✓ — —
Backup of the full set of pa‐ 0-0 (light gray) ✓ ✓ — ✓ ✓ — —
rameters of a SIMO‐ 3UF7900-0AA0 — ✓ ✓ ✓ 1) ✓ ✓ ✓
CODE pro system when the 1-0 (titanium
— ✓ ✓ ✓ 1)
✓ ✓ ✓
device is replaced. If a de‐ gray)
vice is replaced, parameter 3UF7901-0AA0
transfer without PC. 0-0 (light gray)
3UF7901-0AA0
1-0 (titanium
gray)
Initialization module 3UF7902-0AA0 — ✓ ✓ ✓ 1) ✓ ✓ ✓
Storage and initialization of 0-0
device parameters and de‐
vice addressing in motor
control centers.
SIMOCODE pro
68 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
System component, acces‐ MLFB Diagram for for for V PN for pro for for for
sory pro C pro S GP V PB pro V pro V P pro V E
MB RT N IP
U
Y connecting cable — ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Connection of the basic unit and current or
current/voltage measuring module with the
initialization module when using the initiali‐
zation module
Length of sys‐ Length of
tem interface open cable 3UF7931-0CA0
0.1 m end 0-0
0.5 m 1.0 m 3UF7932-0CA0
1.0 m 1.0 m 0-0
1.0 m 3UF7937-0CA0
0-0
Addressing plug 3UF7910-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ — —
Assigning the PROFIBUS/ 0-0
Modbus RTU address with‐
out using a PC/PG to SIMO‐
CODE pro through the sys‐
tem interface
USB PC cable 3UF7941-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
for connecting SIMO‐ 0-A
CODE pro to the USB inter‐
face of a PC/PG
USB-to-serial adapter 3UF7946-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
For connecting an RS 232 PC -0
cable to the interface of a
PC.
Door adapter 3UF7920-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
For bringing out the system 0-0
interface, e.g. out of a cabi‐
net
Adapter for operator pan‐ 3UF7922-0AA0 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
el 0-0
Enables use of the smaller
operator panel (OP) after
system replacement in a
front panel cutout in which,
for example, a larger 3UF5 2
operator panel of SIMO‐
CODE DP had previously
been used.
Degree of protection: IP54.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 69
An overview of system components
System component, acces‐ MLFB Diagram for for for V PN for pro for for for
sory pro C pro S GP V PB pro V pro V P pro V E
MB RT N IP
U
Labeling strips ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
for pushbuttons of the oper‐ 3UF7925-0AA0
ator panel 3UF7 20 0-0
for pushbuttons of the oper‐ 3UF7925-0AA0
ator panel with display 1-0
3UF7 21 3UF7925-0AA0
for LEDs of the operator pan‐ 2-0
el 3UF7 20
Push-in lugs for screw
mounting
e.g. on mounting plate; 2
units required per device
Can be used for the current 3RV2928-0B ✓ ✓ ✓ — ✓ ✓ ✓
measuring modules and
current/voltage measuring
modules
3UF7 1.0, 3UF7 1.1 and 3U
F7 1.2
Can be 3RP19 03 ✓ — — ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
used for 3UF700, 3UF701, 3
UF7 3, 3UF7 4, 3UF7 5 and
3UF7 7
Can be used for 3UF7020- 3ZY1311-0AA0 — ✓ ✓ — — — —
1A.01-0 and 3UF7600-1A.0 0
1-0
Terminal covers
Covers for cable lug and ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
busbar connections: 3RT1956-4EA1
Length 100 mm, can be 3RT1966-4EA1
used for 3UF7 1.3-1BA00-0
Length 120 mm, can be
used for 3UF7 1.4-1BA00-0
Covers for box terminals: ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
Length 25 mm, can be used 3RT1956-4EA2
for 3UF7 1.3-1BA00-0 3RT1966-4EA2
Length 30 mm, can be used
for 3UF7 1.4-1BA00-0
SIMOCODE pro
70 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
An overview of system components
System component, acces‐ MLFB Diagram for for for V PN for pro for for for
sory pro C pro S GP V PB pro V pro V P pro V E
MB RT N IP
U
Covers for screwed con‐ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
nection:
between contactor and cur‐
rent measuring module or
3RT1956-4EA3
between current/voltage
3RT1966-4EA3
measuring module with di‐
rect mounting
can be used for
3UF7 1.3-1BA00-0
can be used for
3UF7 1.4-1BA00-0
Box terminal blocks ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
for round and ribbon cable
conductors 3RT1955-4G
up to 70 mm2, can be used 3RT1956-4G
for 3UF7 1.3-1BA00-0
3RT1966-4G
up to 120 mm2, can be used
for 3UF7 1.3-1BA00-0
up to 240 mm2, can be used
for 3UF7 1.4-1BA00-0
Bus termination module ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
with dedicated power sup‐
ply;
for bus connection after the
last device on the bus
3UF1900-1KA0
Supply voltage: 0
115/230 V AC 3UF1900-1KB0
24 V DC 0
Note
The use of bus connection
modules is recommended,
in particular, when using SI‐
MOCODE pro S.
Bus connecting terminal 3UF7960-0AA0 — ✓ ✓ — — — —
For securing the PROFIBUS 0-0
cable on the SIMO‐
CODE pro S basic unit.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 71
An overview of system components
SIMOCODE pro
72 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components 8
8.1 Basic units (BU)
%DVLF8QLW6,02&2'( SUR 6
The basic units are suitable for DIN rail mounting or with additional push-in lugs for mounting
on a mounting plate. They are always equipped with removable terminals.
The basic units are available in different types for the following supply voltages:
• 24 V DC
• 110 to 240 V AC / DC
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 73
Description of system components
8.1 Basic units (BU)
SIMOCODE pro
74 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.1 Basic units (BU)
"TEST/RESET" button
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 75
Description of system components
8.2 Operator panel (OP)
Enables the device to be reset after tripping or after a fault has occurred and makes it possible
to test the device/motor feeder with or without tripping the contactor control. If a memory
module or addressing plug is plugged in, parameterization can be initiated via the TEST/RESET
button or, for example, by accepting the PROFIBUS address.
You will find further information in Chapter "Test/Reset" in the manual Parameterizing
SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958), in
Chapters Setting the PROFIBUS DP address (Page 236) and Setting IP parameters and PROFINET
device name (Page 240) and in Chapter Backing up and saving parameters (Page 255).
System interfaces
2 system interfaces for connecting
• a current measuring module or a current / voltage measuring module and
• an operator panel or expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
76 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.2 Operator panel (OP)
Labeling strips:
Labeling strips are enclosed for designating buttons 1 to 4 and the yellow LEDs 1 to 3:
• Buttons 1 to 4: 6 pre-assigned labeling strips and 1 individually inscribable labeling strip
• LEDs 1 to 3: 1 individually inscribable labeling strip
6723
&/26( 23(1
23(1 &/26(
/('JUHHQ /('JUHHQ /('JUHHQ /('JUHHQ
%XWWRQ %XWWRQ %XWWRQ %XWWRQ
, 7(67
5(6(7
Figure 8-3 Labeling strips for operator panel buttons and LEDs
Unused labeling strips can be stored on the back of the operator panel:
/DEHOLQJ VWULSV
6WRUDJH FOLSV
Figure 8-4 Storage clips for labeling strips for pushbuttons and LEDs of the operator panel
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 77
Description of system components
8.2 Operator panel (OP)
SIMOCODE pro
78 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
8.3.1 Functions and possible applications of the operator panel with display
Apart from the standard operator panel (OP), an optional operator panel with display (OPD) is
also available for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series. This operator panel can
additionally display current measured values, operating data, diagnostics data or status
information of the motor feeder on the cabinet. It also contains all the status LEDs that are
present on the basic unit and facilitates access to the system interface from outside the cabinet.
The motor can be controlled via the buttons on the operator panel. Current measured values,
status information, fault messages or the device-internal error log are simultaneously shown on
the display.
Note
Usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display
• SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit: The operator panel with display can only be used with
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit from version *E03*.
• SIMOCODE pro V PN, pro V EIP basic unit: An operator panel with display from version *E07*
is required for use with these basic units.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro PN basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro MR basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• When using the "Dry-running protection by means of active power monitoring" function, the
following operator panels with display are necessary:
– 3UF7210-1AA00-0: ≥ E12
– 3UF7210-1AA01-0: ≥ E03
– 3UF7210-1BA00-0: ≥ E04
– 3UF7210-1BA01-0: ≥ E03
Note
Modification of selected device parameters via the operator panel with display
Modification of selected device parameters is possible via the operator panel with display
(see Parameters (Page 110))
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 79
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
The operator panel with display can be connected directly to basic unit SIMOCODE pro V or an
expansion module via the rear system interface. Voltage is supplied by the basic unit. This front
system interface (with cover for IP54) can be used to connect (by means of the PC cable) a PC
with the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) software installed or the memory module and the addressing
plug.
NOTICE
Active operation
You must not remove or plug in the operator panel with display during operation!
Note
When using an operator panel with display, you may have to consider restrictions in the type and
number of expansion modules that can be connected to a basic unit!
See Chapter Configuration information for SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit
(Page 135).
Labeling strips:
Labeling strips for labeling buttons 1 to 4 (6 pre-assigned and 1 that can be labeled individually)
are included:
SIMOCODE pro
80 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
%XWWRQ
/('JUHHQ
%XWWRQ
/('JUHHQ
%XWWRQ
/('JUHHQ
%XWWRQ
/('JUHHQ
&/26(
, 23(1 23(1
6723 &/26(
Figure 8-7 Labeling strips for the buttons of the operator panel with display
Unused labeling strips can be stored on the back of the operator panel with display:
/DEHOLQJ VWULSV
6WRUDJH FOLSV
Figure 8-8 Storage clips for labeling strips
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 81
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
8.3.2 Operator controls and display elements of the operator panel with display
,/ $
,/ $
,/ $
$7 0HQX
Figure 8-10 Display elements of the operator panel with display
1
Shows the current setting Is / rated motor current in A. For motors with two speeds, the relevant
current setting Is1 or Is2 is always displayed depending on whether the current speed is slow or
fast, e.g. 8 A. For motors with two speeds, the left-hand softkey can be used when the motor is
SIMOCODE pro
82 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
stopped to alternate between the display of the two current settings. When running, the current
setting for the active motor speed is always displayed.
2
Shows the set class time of the overload protection, e.g.: 10 = class 10E (class = trip class)
3
Indicates that temperature monitoring is active, e.g. the motor temperature is being monitored
by thermistors or analog temperature sensors (Pt100, Pt1000, KTY, NTC). (T= temperature
monitoring active.)
4
The main display enables customized depiction of different measured values when running.
This is the standard display at the topmost menu level. Predefined profiles in the display settings
can be selected for this purpose. By pressing the "Menu" softkey on the right, you can navigate
through the submenus of the main display (see Chapter Read and adapt main display
(Page 101)).
Figure 8-11 Operator controls of the operator panel with display
1
Four freely parameterizable operator keys with status LED. These operator keys are used to
control the motor with integrated status LEDs for any status feedback. The functions can be user-
defined. Labeling can be either freely chosen or achieved using the labeling strips supplied with
the device (see also Chapter Operator panel with display (Page 79) and Chapters "Operator panel
LED" and "Operator panel buttons" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958))
2
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 83
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Two softkeys. They can have different functions depending on the menu displayed (e.g. open
menu, exit menu, TEST/RESET). The currently assigned functions are shown on the lower left or
right edge of the display.
3
Two arrow keys (one upwards arrow and one downwards arrow). They serve to navigate the
menu or change the display settings, e.g. to adjust the contrast or to select a profile for the main
display.
SIMOCODE pro
84 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
0DLQGLVSOD\ ,GHQWLILFDWLRQ
0HDVXUHGYDOXHVGLVSOD\ $ERXW6,02&2'(
6WDWLVWLFVPDLQWHQDQFH
&RPPXQLFDWLRQ
'HYLFH,2V
3DUDPHWHU
'LVSOD\VHWWLQJV
&RPPDQGV
6WDWXVLQIRUPDWLRQ
:DUQLQJV
)DXOWV
(UURUEXIIHU
(YHQWPHPRU\
23'DERYH
(
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 85
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
,/,/,/>$@ 7HPSHUDWXUHPRGXOH
PD[7HPSHUDWXUH>r&r)@
777>r&r)@
3KDVHXQEDODQFH>@
7KHUPDOPRWRUPRGHOO>@
3KDVHYROWDJHV
7LPHWRWULS>V@
8/18/18/1
&RROLQJGRZQSHULRG>V@
/LQHWROLQHYROWDJHV
RQO\23'DERYH
(
/DVWWULSFXUUHQW>$@
8//8//8//
3RZHU36&RV3KL
&RV3KL>DEV@
3>N:@6>N9$@
([WHUQDO(DUWK)DXOW
(DUWKIDXOWFXUUHQW>$@
ODVWWULSSFXUUHQW>$@
$QDORJ,2V
$QDORJPRGXOH
(($>P$@
$QDORJPRGXOH
(($>P$@
Note
Numbering of the displays
The numbering is valid with the maximum expansion.
SIMOCODE pro
86 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
'0)/RFDO
*HQHUDOIDXOW (QDEOLQJFLUFXLW
*HQHUDOZDUQLQJ 6ZLWFKRII
6DIHW\RN 6DIHW\
'0)/RFDO
&XUUHQWIORZLQJ
'HYLFHRN
',36DIHW\
'0)352),VDIH
%XVRN (QDEOLQJFLUFXLWV
6363/6LQ5XQ 6ZLWFKRII
352),VDIHRN 6DIHW\
,QWHUORFNLQJWLPHDFWLYH 3KDVHVHTXHQFH
&KDQJHRYHUSDXVHDFW
)& )2
7& 72
3RVLWLRQHU
&ORVHV
2SHQV
1RQPDLQWDLQHG
FRPPDQGPRGH
3URWHFWLRQ
&RROLQJGRZQSHULRGDFW
3DXVHWLPHDFWLYH
(PHUJHQF\VWDUWH[HFXWHG
Figure 8-14 Status motor protection/motor control, operator panel with display -
PROFIBUS / Modbus RTU
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 87
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
'0)/RFDO
*HQHUDOIDXOW (QDEOLQJFLUFXLW
*HQHUDOZDUQLQJ 6ZLWFKRII
6DIHW\RN 6DIHW\
'0)/RFDO
&XUUHQWIORZLQJ
'HYLFHRN
',36DIHW\
'0)352),VDIH
%XVRN (QDEOLQJFLUFXLWV
6363/6LQ5XQ 6ZLWFKRII
352),VDIHRN 6DIHW\
352),HQHUJ\
21 21
2)) 21! 0LVFHOODQHRXV
21!! 6WDUWDFWLYH
,QWHUORFNLQJWLPHDFWLYH 'HYLFHWHVW
&KDQJHRYHUSDXVHDFW DFWLYH
232
5HPRWH 3KDVHVHTXHQFH
73)
RQO\23'DERYH
(
)& )2
7& 72
3RVLWLRQHU
&ORVHV
2SHQV
1RQPDLQWDLQHG
FRPPDQGPRGH
3URWHFWLRQ
&RROLQJGRZQSHULRGDFW
3DXVHWLPHDFWLYH
(PHUJHQF\VWDUWH[HFXWHG
Figure 8-15 Status motor protection/motor control, operator panel with display - PROFINET / EtherNet/
IP
SIMOCODE pro
88 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
6WDUWVSRVVLEOH
2QHPRUHVWDUWRQO\SRVVLEOH &DOFXODWRU
1RVWDUWSRVVLEOH
(QHUJ\FRQVXPHG>N:K@
1XPEHURISDUDPHWHUL]DWLRQV
2SHUDWLQJKRXUVEDVLFXQLW>K@
7LPHU
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 89
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
6WDUWVSRVVLEOH
2QHPRUHVWDUWRQO\SRVVLEOH &DOFXODWRU
1RVWDUWSRVVLEOH
1XPEHURISDUDPHWHUL]DWLRQV
2SHUDWLQJKRXUVEDVLFXQLW>K@
5HDOWLPHEDVLFXQLW
7LPHU
SIMOCODE pro
90 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
'LDJQRVWLFV
352),%860RGEXVDGGUHVV 'HYLFHIDXOW
(YHQW
352),VDIHDGGUHVV 'LDJQRVWLFV
23'DERYH
(
DQG%DVLF8QLW :DUQLQJ
6,02&2'(SUR9DERYH
(
)DXOW
%DXGUDWH
%XV
RN
0RQLWRULQJ
3/&3&6
LQ5XQ
0RQLWRULQJ
%XV3/&IDXOW5HVHW
0DQXDO
$XWR
&RPPXQLFDWLRQ
6WDUWXSSDUDPHWHUEORFN
7LPHVWDPSLQJ
$FWLYH
&RPSDWLELOLW\PRGH
&RPSDWLELOLW\PRGH
8)PRGH
8)2SHUDWLQJPRGH
'39
'39
8)EDVLFW\SH
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 91
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
'LDJQRVWLFV
,3FRQILJXUDWLRQ 'HYLFHIDXOW
(YHQW
'LDJQRVWLFV
,3DGGUHVV :DUQLQJ
)DXOW
6XEQHWPDVN
$GGUHVVURXWHU
'HYLFHQDPH
0$&DGGUHVV
352),VDIHDGGUHVV
%DXGUDWH
%XV
RN
0RQLWRULQJ
3/&3&6
LQ5XQ
0RQLWRULQJ
%XV3/&IDXOW5HVHW
0DQXDO
$XWR
&RPPXQLFDWLRQ
6WDUWXSSDUDPHWHUEORFN
7LPHVWDPSLQJ
$FWLYH
SIMOCODE pro
92 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
'0 '0)/RFDO
,QSXWV ,1 6WDUW
%DVLF8QLW )HHGEDFNFLUFXLW 7HPSHUDWXUHPRGXOH
&DVFDGHG
'0 '0)/RFDO
,QSXWV 6HQVRUFKDQQHOV
PD[WHPS>r&)@
'0 '0)/RFDO
2XWSXWV 2XWSXWV '0)/RFDO
777>r&)@
(QDEOLQJFLUFXLW
'0 '0)352),VDIH
37& ,QSXWV 6HQVRUW\SH 3W 3W
17& .7<
+LJKUHVLVWDQFHQRWSUHVHQW )HHGEDFNFLUFXLW .7<
'0 '0)352),VDIH
37& 2XWSXWV '0)352),VDIH 6HQVRU
RN )DXOW
6KRUWFLUFXLW (QDEOLQJFLUFXLW 2XWRI5DQJH
(0
,/,/,/>$@ *URXQGIDXOWFXUUHQW>$@
(0
,QSXWV
9ROWDJHPHDVXULQJ 2SHQFLUFXLW
6KRUWFLUFXLW
RU 8//8//8//>9@ ,QSXWV
RQO\23'DERYH
(
,QSXWV
2XWSXW>P$@
0RQRVWDEOHRXWSXWV ,QSXWV
2SHQFLUFXLW
%LVWDEOHRXWSXWV
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 93
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
6HWFXUUHQW,V,V
7ULS,!,
&XUUHQW/LPLWV :DUQLQJ,,
6WDOOHG5RWRU
9ROWDJH 7ULS
/LPLWV :DUQLQJ
&RV3KL 7ULS
/LPLWV :DUQLQJ
$FWLYH3RZHU 7ULS3!3
/LPLWV :DUQLQJ33
([WHUQDO 7ULS
(DUWK)DXOW :DUQLQJ
P$ $07ULS!
/LPLWV $0:DUQLQJ!
7HPSHUDWXUH 707ULS!
/LPLWV 70:DUQLQJ!
/LPLW /LPLW
PRQLWRU
Figure 8-21 Parameter settings, operator panel with display
1)
Overview of the basic units and operator panels and their product versions, which permit the
setting of parameters via the operator panel with display:
Operator panel
3UF7210-1AA00- 3UF7210-1BA0 3UF7210-1AA01 3UF7210-1BA01
0 0-0 -0 -0
SIMOCODE pro V PN 3UF7011-1A.00-0 E01 E07 E01 E01 E01
SIMOCODE pro V EIP 3UF7013-1A.00-0 E01 E07 E01 E01 E01
SIMO‐ 3UF7010-1A.00-0 E15 E10 E02 E01 E01
CODE pro V PROFI‐
BUS
SIMOCODE pro V MR 3UF7012-1A.00-0 E03 E10 E02 E01 E01
You will find usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display in Chapter Functions
and possible applications of the operator panel with display (Page 79).
7 Display settings, operator panel with display
Details: See Adapt display settings (Page 112).
SIMOCODE pro
94 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
/DQJXDJHV
8)b$$ 8)b%$
(QJOLVK (QJOLVK
'HXWVFK ₼⦌
)UDQ©DLV ̷͚͑͘͘͏͐
&RQWUDVW>@ 3ROVNL 뼑霢꽩
(VSDQRO
3RUWXJX¬V
,WDOLDQR
6XRPL
,OOXPLQDWLRQ>2IIV
VPLQPLQ@
,/,O,/>$@
,/,O,/>@
,PD[>$@
3URILOHV ,PD[>@
,PD[&RV
,PD[8/1&RV6
,PD[8//&RV6
,PD[8/1&RV3
,PD[8//&RV3
9ROWDJHGLVSOD\ >P$@,QSXW2XWSXW$0
>P$@,QSXW2XWSXW$0
>P$@,QSXW,QSXW$0
>P$@,QSXW2XWSXW$0
>P$@,QSXW2XWSXW$0
3KDVHYROWDJHV >P$@,QSXW,QSXW$0
PD[7HPSHUDWXUHr&70
7HPSHUDWXUHr&70
PD[7HPSHUDWXUHr)70
7HPSHUDWXUr)70
/LQHWROLQHYROWDJHV PD[7HPSHUDWXUHr&70
7HPSHUDWXUHr&70
PD[7HPSHUDWXUHr)70
7HPSHUDWXUHr)70
:DUQLQJV 8/18/18/1
'RQRWGLVSOD\ 8//8//8//
'LVSOD\ ,PD[8/1&RV
,PD[8//&RV
,PD[8/17PD[r&
)DXOWV ,PD[8//7PD[r&
'RQRWGLVSOD\ ,PD[8/17PD[r)
'LVSOD\ ,PD[8//7PD[r)
&DOFXODWRU
&DOFXODWRU
5HWXUQWRPDLQ (QHUJ\FRQVXPHG>N:K@
GLVSOD\>0DQXDOVV
PLQPLQ@ RQO\23'DERYH
(
)DFWRU\VHWWLQJV
'LVSOD\
5HVWRUH
GLVSOD\VHWWLQJV
8 commands, operator panel with display (for pro V PB / pro V MR basic units)
Details: See Resetting, testing and parameterizing via commands (Page 114).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 95
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
&RPPDQGV
([HFXWH7HVW5HVHW
352),%860RGEXV
$SSO\DGGUHVV
0HPRU\0RGXOH
3URJUDP
0HPRU\0RGXOH
&OHDU
0HPRU\0RGXOH
5HDG
'HYLFH
5HVWDUW
%DVLF8QLW
)DFWRU\VHWWLQJV
Figure 8-23 Commands, operator panel with display
7KHUPLVWRUWULS
:DUQLQJ7!
7KHUPLVWRUWULS
:DUQLQJ7!
SIMOCODE pro
96 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
7ULS7!
2YHUORDGSKDVHIDLOXUH
)DXOW
)DXOW
13 Event memory, operator panel with display (only for OPD as from *E06* and BU2 as from
*E07*)
Details: See Reading out the device-internal event memory (Page 116).
'0 '0)/RFDORU'0)352),VDIH
(YHQWPHPRU\
'0 '0)/RFDO
(QDEOLQJFLUFXLW!
'0 '0)352),VDIH
(QDEOLQJFLUFXLW!
352),VDIH$GGUHVV
'0 '0)/RFDORU'0)352),VDIH
(QDEOLQJFLUFXLW!
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 97
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
6\VWHP
,GHQWLILFDWLRQ 6,02&2'(SUR
Date FW version
0/)% 0/)%
Manufacturer FW version
6,(0(16
Device family
Load feeder
Device subfamily
Motor management
Device class
6,02&2'(SUR9
SIMOCODE pro
98 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Operator panel
3UF7210-1AA00- 3UF7210-1BA00- 3UF7210-1AA01 3UF7210-1BA01
0 0 -0 -0
SIMOCODE pro V PN 3UF7011-1A.00-0 E01 E07 E01 E01 E01
SIMOCODE pro V EIP 3UF7013-1A.00-0 E01 E07 E01 E01 E01
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 99
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
You will find usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display in Chapter Functions
and possible applications of the operator panel with display (Page 79).
• Display settings
All settings relevant to the operator panel with display can be carried out via "Display
Settings". In addition to selecting the language and adjusting the contrast or illumination, it
is also possible to select the profiles here that are relevant for adjusting the main display. For
detailed information: See also "Adapt display settings (Page 112)."
• Commands
The "Commands" menu item contains all commands relating to SIMOCODE pro, e.g. for
testing the feeder, resetting after tripping and/or transferring parameters into the memory
module or into SIMOCODE pro. For detailed information: See "Resetting, testing and
parameterizing via commands (Page 114)."
• Messages
The "Status Information" menu item provides an overview of all pending status information.
For detailed information: See "Display of all pending status information (Page 115)."
• Warnings
The "Warnings" menu item provides an overview of all pending warnings. For detailed
information: See "Display of all pending warnings (Page 115)."
• Faults
The "Faults" menu item provides an overview of all pending faults. For detailed information:
See "Display of all pending faults (Page 116)."
• Error buffer
The "Error buffer" menu item displays the SIMOCODE pro device-internal error buffer. For
detailed information: See "Reading out the device-internal error buffer (Page 116)."
• Event memory
The "Event Memory" menu item enables access to the SIMOCODE pro device-internal event
memory. For detailed information: See "Reading out the device-internal event memory
(Page 116)."
Note
Precondition for event memory display
Is only displayed if DM-F present.
• Identification
In the "Identification" menu item, you will find detailed information/labeling regarding
SIMOCODE pro hardware components (basic unit, operator panel with display). For detailed
information: See "Identification of the motor feeder and the SIMOCODE pro components
(Page 117)."
• About SIMOCODE
The "About SIMOCODE" menu item displays further information about SIMOCODE pro.
See Timing charts (Page 84).
SIMOCODE pro
100 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 101
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Shows the current value at the two inputs of analog module 1 / 2 in mA.
• Max. temp. °C TM 1 / TM2 6)
Shows the maximum temperature of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature
module 1 / 2 in °C.
• Temperatures °C TM 1 / TM2 6)
Shows the individual temperatures of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature
module 1 / 2 in °C.
• Max. temp. °F TM 1 / TM2 6)
Shows the maximum temperature of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature
module 1 / 2 in °F.
• Temperatures °F TM 1 / TM2 6)
Shows the individual temperatures of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature
module 1 / 2 in °F.
• UL1-N, UL2-N, UL3-N 3)
Shows all phase voltages in V.
• UL1-L1, UL2-L3, UL3-L1 4)
Shows line-to-line voltages UL1-L2, UL2-L3, UL3-L1 in V.
• Imax, UL1-N, Cos phi 3)
Shows the maximum current of all three phases in amps, the phase voltage UL1-N in V, and the
power factor as absolute values.
• Imax, UL1-L2, Cos phi 4)
Shows the maximum current of all three phases in A, the line-to-line voltage UL1-L2 in V and the
power factor.
• Imax, UL1-N, °C 7)
Shows the maximum current of all three phases in amps, the phase voltage UL1-N in V, and the
maximum temperature of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature module in °C.
• Imax, UL1-L2, °F 7)
Shows the maximum current of all three phases in A, the line-to-line voltage UL1-L2 in V, and the
maximum temperature of all used sensor measuring circuits of the temperature module in °F.
• Calculator 1
Shows the calculated result that the function block Calculator 1 provides without units in the
range 0 ... 65535.
Permits display, for example, of a 2-byte value sent directly from the automation system on the
display of the switchboard or the display without units of each 2-byte value in SIMOCODE pro.
• Calculator 2
Shows the calculated result that the function block Calculator 2 provides without units in the
range 0 ... 65535.
SIMOCODE pro
102 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Permits display, for example, of a 2-byte or 4-byte value sent directly from the automation
system on the display of the switchboard or the display without units of each 2-byte and 4-byte
value in SIMOCODE pro.
• Energy consumed 2)
Note
Modified system expansion or hardware configuration
If the main display permanently fails to show measured values, this indicates that a profile has
been selected in the display settings that is no longer supported, due, for example, to a changed
system expansion or changed hardware configuration. The profile must be reselected.
1) Possible only if a current measuring module or current / voltage measuring module is used
2) Possible only if a current / voltage measuring module is used
3) Possible only if a current / voltage measuring module is used Values will only be displayed if
phase voltage is set/configured
4) Possible only if a current / voltage measuring module is used and line-to-line voltage is set/
configured
5) Possible only if the analog module is used
6) Possible only if the temperature module is used
7) Possible only if a current / voltage measuring module and temperature module are used
Values will only be displayed if phase voltage is set/configured
The "Measured Values" menu item displays all current SIMOCODE pro measured values.
Depending upon the type of expansion modules used, all or only some of the values listed here
will be available. These are the most important menus by way of example:
• Imax 1)
Shows the maximum current of all three phases and can be switched between A or % of Is
• IL1, IL2, IL3 1)
Shows the currents of all three phases and can be switched between A or % of Is.
• Phase unbalance 1)
Shows the current phase unbalance as a percentage.
• UL1-N, UL2-N, UL3-N 2)
Shows all phase voltages in V.
• U L1-L2, U L2-L3, U L3-L1 3)
Shows all line-to-line voltages in V.
• Cos phi, P, S 4)
Shows the power factor (0 to 100 % or absolute, switchable using the right softkey), the
active power in kW, and the apparent power in kVA.
• Frequency [Hz] 7)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 103
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
SIMOCODE pro
104 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
General
• General fault, general warning
• Current flowing, device ok
• Bus ok, PLC/PCS in Run
Control
Note
Display status information
The display of the status information can vary according to the control function.
Protection
• Cooling down period active, pause time active, emergency start executed
Other
• Device test active
• Phase sequence 1-2-3, phase sequence 3-2-1
Possible only if a current / voltage measuring module is used.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 105
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Safety
• Safety DM-F Local: Status of enabling circuit, shutdown "Safety," "Safety o.k." (only with an
OPD as from product version *E04*, a SIMOCODE pro V MR / PN / EIP basic unit or a
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit as from product version *E07* and a DM-F Local)
• DIP switches, DM-F Local: Status of DIP switches 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 (only with an OPD as from
product version *E04*, a SIMOCODE pro V MR/PN/EIP basic unit or a SIMOCODE pro V PB basic
unit as from product version *E07* and a DM-F Local)
• Safety DM-F PROFIsafe: Status of enabling circuit, shutdown "Safety," "PROFIsafe active" (only
with an OPD as from product version *E04*, a SIMOCODE pro V PN basic unit or a
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit as from product version *E07* and a DM-F PROFIsafe).
The "Statistics/Maintenance" menu item gives an overview of all SIMOCODE pro information that
is primarily relevant to maintenance. The states of timers and counters, etc. are displayed, as
well as operating hours, stop times and the number of starts.
These are the most important menus by way of example:
General
• Number of overload trips
• Motor operating hours
• Motor operating hours >: Displays overshooting of the set limit for operating hours
monitoring.
• No. of starts - actual value
• Permissible starts - actual value
• One more start only, no start
• Stop time: Displays overshooting of the set limit for motor stop time monitoring.
• Energy consumed (possible only if a current / voltage measuring module is used)
• Number of parameterizations
• Motor operating hours basic unit
• Real time basic unit
• Timer
• Timer 1 (2, 3, 4, 5, 6) actual value
• Timer 1 (2, 3, 4, 5, 6) output
• Counter
• Counter 1 (2, 3, 4, 5, 6) actual value
• Counter 1 (2, 3, 4, 5, 6) output
SIMOCODE pro
106 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Calculators
• Calculator 1
• Calculator 2
• Calculator 3
• Calculator 4
Safety
• Time until test requirement: Remaining time until next test requirement in weeks (displayed
only when DM-F is installed).
PROFIBUS/Modbus:
In addition to the current PROFIBUS/Modbus device address, the baud rate or fieldbus-relevant
settings concerning process and diagnostic alarms to the automation system.
These are the most important menus by way of example:
• PROFIBUS/Modbus address
• PROFIsafe address: Indicates the PROFIsafe address (only for OPD versions as from *E04*,
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit as from *E07* and an available with a DM-F PROFIsafe)
• Baud rate
• Bus ok, Bus monitoring
• PLC/PCS in Run, PLC/PCS monitoring
• Bus/PLC fault - reset
• Startup parameter block
• Time stamping active
• Compatibility mode
• Compatibility mode 1, 3UF50 Mode
• 3UF50 mode DPV0, DPV1
• 3UF50 basic type
• Diagnostics device error, diagnostics message: Displays which diagnostic information of type
"device error" and/or "message" is sent by SIMOCODE pro to a higher-level automation system
via PROFIBUS.
• Diagnostics warning, diagnostics trip: Displays which diagnostic information of type
"warning" and/or "trip" is sent by SIMOCODE pro to a higher-level automation system via
PROFIBUS.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 107
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
PROFINET:
Not only information about IP configuration, device name, MAC address, PROFIsafe address but
also settings about the status of communication and the response of SIMOCODE pro if
communication failures are displayed.
These are the most important menus by way of example:
• IP configuration
• Device name
• MAC address
• PROFIsafe address: Shows the PROFIsafe address (only when DM-F PROFIsafe is installed)
• Baud rate
• Bus OK, bus monitoring
• PLC/PCS in Run, PLC/PCS monitoring
• Bus/PLC fault - reset
• Startup parameter block
• Diagnostics device error, diagnostics message: Shows which type of diagnostic information
is sent by SIMOCODE pro to a higher-level automation system via PROFINET.
• Diagnostics warning, diagnostics trip: Shows which type of diagnostic information is sent by
SIMOCODE pro to a higher-level automation system via PROFINET.
Basic unit
• Inputs 1 (2, 3, 4)
• Outputs 1 (2, 3)
• PTC high resistance/not present
• PTC ok, PTC short circuit
Current measurement
IL1, Il2, IL3: Displays the currents (in A) in all three phases (possible only if a current measuring
module or current / voltage measuring module is used).
SIMOCODE pro
108 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Voltage measurement
• UL1-N, UL2-N, UL3-N: Displays all line-to-line voltages in V (possible only if a current / voltage
measuring module is used and the OPD is version *E04* or higher and line-to-line voltage is
set/configured).
• U L1-L2, U L2-L3, U L3-L1: Displays all line-to-line voltages in V (possible only if a current /
voltage measuring module is used, line-to-line voltage is set/configured and the OPD used is
version *E04* or higher).
Note
Display
For OPD up to product version *E03*, the display is different.
Ground-fault module
Possible only if the ground-fault module is used.
• Ground-fault current [mA]
• Inputs
- Open circuit
- Short-circuit.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 109
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Analog module
Possible only if the analog module is used.
• Input 1, input 2
• Output
• Open circuit
Temperature module
Possible only if the temperature module is used.
• Max. temperature
• T1, T2, T3
• Sensor type Pt100, Pt1000, NTC, KTY83, KTY85
• Sensor fault sensor out of range
8.3.3.9 Parameters
You can set the following parameters using the operator panel with display:
SIMOCODE pro
110 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 111
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Note
Password protection
It is only possible to change these parameters if password protection is not active. Only then can
you choose the parameter to be modified with the "OK" button.
The default settings configured in the basic unit can be modified via the display settings.
However, changes made in this way do not result in a change to the configured defaults. In
addition to selecting the language and adjusting the contrast or illumination, it is also possible
to select the profiles here that are relevant for adjusting the main display. In the factory settings
menu item, the changes made to the display settings can be reset to the values configured in the
basic unit.
These are the most important menus by way of example:
Languages
English (default), German, French, Polish, Spanish, Portuguese, Italian, Finnish
or alternatively
English, Chinese, Russian, Korean.
Contrast
0 % to 100 % (default: 50 %)
Illumination
Specifies how long the backlit display will remain on on the operator panel with display after the
last keystroke and enables permanent activation or deactivation of the backlit display. Off, 3 s,
10 s (default), 1 min, 5 min
SIMOCODE pro
112 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Profiles
Enables selection of the display profiles for the main display. If a defined profile is no longer
supported by SIMOCODE pro, for example, due to a changed hardware configuration, the start
display will be shown instead of the default main display:
• IL1, IL2, IL3 [A] (default)
• Imax [A]
• IL1, IL2, IL3 [%]
• Imax [%]
• Imax, Cos phi
• Imax, UL1-N, Cos phi, S
• Imax, UL1-L2, Cos phi, S
• Imax, UL1-N, Cos phi, P
• Imax, UL1-L2, Cos phi, P
• In1/output AM1 [mA] (only if analog module 1 is present and configured)
• In2/output AM1 [mA] (only if analog module 1 is present and configured)
• In1/output AM2 [mA] (only if analog module 2 is present and configured)
• In2/output AM2 [mA] (only if analog module 2 is present and configured)
• Inputs AM 1 / inputs AM2 [mA]
• Max. temp. °C/°F TM1 (only if temperature module 1 is present and configured)
• Temperatures °C/°F TM1 (only if temperature module 1 is present and configured)
• Max. temp. °C/°F TM2 (only if temperature module 2 is present and configured)
• Temperatures °C/°F TM2 (only if temperature module 2 is present and configured)
• UL1-N, UL2-N, UL3-N
• UL1-L2, UL2-L3, UL3-L1
• Imax, UL1-N, Cos phi
• Imax, UL1-L2, Cos phi
• Imax, UL1-N °C/°F (temperature display TM1! 1))
• Imax, UL1-L2, °C/°F 1) (temperature display TM1! 1))
• Calculator 1
• Calculator 2
• Energy consumed [kWh] (only if a current / voltage measuring module is configured).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 113
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
NOTICE
1) Temperatures
The temperature from temperature module 1 is always shown in this display profile.
The temperature from temperature module 2 is not shown in this profile.
Voltage display
Switch voltage display: Defines whether "phase voltages" or "line-to-line voltages" will be
displayed (available only with an OPD as from product version *E04* and a SIMOCODE pro V PB
basic unit up to product version *E06*). Configuration is performed in the basic unit as from
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit, product version *E07*.
Warnings
Determines whether, in the case of a pending general warning, the display is switched over to
the menu item "Warnings" so that details are displayed (not activated per default): Do not display
(default) - Display
Faults
Determines whether, in the case of a pending general fault, the display is switched over to the
menu item "Faults" so that details are displayed (switched on per default, higher priority than
pending warnings): Do not display - Display (default)
The "Commands" menu item contains all commands relating to SIMOCODE pro, e.g. for testing
the feeder, resetting after tripping and/or transferring parameters into the memory module or
into SIMOCODE pro.
SIMOCODE pro
114 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Restart
Initialization of SIMOCODE pro. New start.
Factory settings
All parameters assume their factory settings again.
Test
Execute the test function. Same function as "TEST/RESET" button on the basic unit and operator
panel
Reset
Execute a reset operation. Same function at "TEST/RESET" button on the basic unit and operator
panel.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 115
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Event memory
The event memory is displayed.
Note
Requirements
Possible only if digital module 1 is used as a DM-F Local module.
Note
Requirements
Possible only if digital module 1 is used as a DM-F PROFIsafe module.
SIMOCODE pro
116 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.3 Operator panel with display
Note
Requirements
Possible only if digital module 1 is used as a DM-F Local or DM-F PROFIsafe module.
8.3.3.17 Identification of the motor feeder and the SIMOCODE pro components
In the "Identification" menu item, you will find detailed information about the used SIMOCODE
pro hardware components, e.g. hardware and firmware versions. This dialog box also enables
identification of the motor feeder via a plant identifier stored in SIMOCODE pro, as well as a
request for the location designation and display of the device's internal comment.
The essential menus are described by way of an example below:
Identification
• Plant identifier
• Location designation
• Date installed
• Description
Basic unit
• Order number
• Short code
• Vendor
• Device subfamily
• Device class
• System
• Ident. no.
• Hardware version
• Firmware version
• Time stamp
Display
• Order number
• Hardware version
• Firmware version
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 117
Description of system components
8.4 Current measuring modules (IM) for the SIMOCODE pro C, SIMOCODE pro S, and SIMOCODE pro V device series
$ $ $ $
$ $
$$ $$
The current measuring module is connected to the basic unit via a connecting cable, which also
supplies the power. Current measuring modules up to 100 A are suitable for standard rail
mounting or can be fixed directly to the mounting plate using additional push-in lugs. Basic units
can be snapped directly onto the current measuring modules. Current measuring modules up to
200 A can also be mounted on the standard mounting rail or, optionally, they can be fixed
directly to the mounting plate with the screw attachments that are integrated in the enclosure.
SIMOCODE pro
118 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
The current measuring module up to 630 A can only be mounted using the integrated screw
attachments.
Note
Current measuring modules with a current setting of up to 100 A can be connected to the basic
unit mechanically and be installed as a unit (behind one another). Larger current measuring
modules can only be mounted separately.
Variants
Two device generations of the current / voltage measuring modules are available:
Note
When using the 2nd generation current / voltage acquisition modules (UM+), no decoupling
module must be connected.
Function
The SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series allows use of a current / voltage measuring
module instead of a current measuring module. In addition to measuring the motor current,
current / voltage measuring modules also enable:
• Monitoring voltages up to 690 V (UM, UM+)
• Calculation and monitoring of power and cos phi (UM, UM+)
• Determining the frequency (UM+)
• Monitoring the phase sequence (UM, UM+)
With SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), you can define under "Parameters → Device
configuration → Display voltage" whether the phase voltage or line-to-line voltage is to be used
system-wide (when using a SIMOCODE pro V High Performance basic unit from firmware
version V3.0).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 119
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
Current / voltage measuring modules are available for the following current ranges:
The diagram below shows the various current / voltage measuring modules:
SIMOCODE pro
120 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
$ $ $ $
$ $
$ $ $ $
$ $
$$ $$
Wiring:
The current / voltage measuring modules are connected to the basic unit via a connecting cable,
which also supplies the power.
For the purpose of calculating or monitoring power-related measured values, current / voltage
measuring modules are equipped with additional, removable terminals to which the voltages of
all three phases of the main circuit are connected. An additional 3-core cable can be used, for
example, to connect the main circuit directly from the bus connections of the current / voltage
measuring module with the connection terminals of the voltage measuring module.
Mounting:
The current / voltage measuring modules UM / UM+ with a current setting of up to 115 A are
suitable for standard rail mounting or can be fixed directly to the mounting plate using additional
push-in lugs. These can be connected to the basic unit mechanically and installed as a unit
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 121
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
(behind one another). For current / voltage measuring modules UM+ with a current setting of up
to 115 A it is possible to mount the basic unit on the current / voltage measuring module.
Current / voltage measuring modules with a setting current up to 200 A can also be mounted on
the standard mounting rail or, optionally, they can be fixed directly to the mounting plate with
the screw attachments that are integrated in the enclosure.
The current / voltage measuring module with a current setting of up to 630 A can only be
mounted using the integrated screw attachments. In this case, basic units can only be installed
separately next to the current / voltage measuring modules.
Application notes when using a 2nd generation current / voltage measuring module
Note
MLFB
The MLFBs of 2nd generation current / voltage measuring modules end
in 010 (e.g. 3UF71101AA010)
SIMOCODE pro
122 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
The measurement ranges of the current / voltage measuring modules have been adjusted to the
current ranges of SIRIUS Innovations contactors and load feeders. This results in increases to the
following measuring ranges: 0.3 to 4 A; 3 to 40 A and 10 to 115 A.
The measured values with the accuracy figures mentioned can be found in data record 94 -
Measured values (from byte position 132) and in data record 95 - Statistics data in the manual
SIMOCODE pro - Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743960).
1)
Note
Frequency measurement
For a correct frequency measurement, the voltage measurement must be connected.
Measurement performance
The rate of measured value acquisition has been improved, and so updating of all measured
values within 200 ms can be assumed.
Tripping characteristic
The overload tripping characteristic, which is calculated in the measuring modules, has been
revised in the 2nd generation current / voltage measuring modules. By means of diverse
analyses, the characteristic curve has been adjusted further to the actual requirements for
overload release.
The tripping characteristic fulfills all basic points defined for overload protection
in IEC 60947-4-1. In particular in the range of the 2-fold motor rated current, the characteristic
curve was approximated to the practical conditions. Thus, the characteristic curve has
steepened slightly, which produces slower tripping in the range between 1.15-fold and 6-fold
motor rated current, and faster tripping in the range above 6-fold motor rated current.
The tripping characteristics can be found in Chapter "Overload protection" in the manual
Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743958).
The trip classes have been extended with trip class 7. Thus, if required, finer coordination of the
trip classes can be chosen in the lower range (if, for example, there is a wish to approximate to
the characteristic curve of the class 10E current measuring modules).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 123
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
NOTICE
Connecting current / voltage measuring modules to the basic unit
The 2nd generation current / voltage measuring modules must be connected directly to the
basic unit in order to achieve the full performance capability.
NOTICE
Compatibility/compatibility mode
• The 2nd generation current / voltage measuring modules also function with older
SIMOCODE basic units. In this case, they behave compatibly with the 1st generation
current / voltage measuring modules and can replace them in an application (compatibility
mode). The prerequisite is that the current setting must lie within the permitted range of the
2nd generation current/voltage measuring module. Example: A 1st generation current /
voltage measuring module 3UF7111-1AA00-0 (2.4 - 25 A) is to be replaced. If the current
setting lies within the range of 2.4 to 3.0 A, a 2nd generation current / voltage measuring
module 3UF7110-1AA01-0 (0.3 - 4 A) must be used.
• If both the SIMOCODE pro basic unit and also the current / voltage measuring module are
replaced and the hardware parameterization is unchanged (the SIMOCODE ES
parameterization still contains a 1st generation current / voltage measuring module), the
compatibility mode of the current / voltage measuring module is also active.
• In the event that a 1st generation current / voltage measuring module is replaced by a
2nd generation current / voltage measuring module, an existing decoupling module must
be removed to ensure fault-free operation.
Specifically, this means:
• The tripping characteristic remains as in the 1st generation current / voltage measuring
modules.
• The measurement accuracy figures and measured values correspond to those of the 1st
generation current / voltage measuring modules.
• The new measured values stored as float in the data records are not entered (see manual
SIMOCODE pro - Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743960) → Tables, data records - definitions").
SIMOCODE pro
124 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.5 Current / voltage measuring modules (UM, UM+) for the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
NOTICE
Maximum configuration of the SIMOCODE system with older basic units
SIMOCODE pro V PB (≤ E14) or pro V MR (E01) and a 2nd generation current / voltage
measuring module
• When using BU / UM+: max. 4 expansion modules
• When using BU / UM+ / OP:
– max. 4 expansion modules
– max. 3 expansion modules when using AM, TM and EM
• when using BU / UM+ / OPD: Max. 3 expansion modules, of which one AM, TM or EM or max.
2 expansion modules from AM, TM and EM when using a BU 24 V DC
• when using BU / UM+ / OPD: Max. 2 expansion modules, of which one AM, TM or EM when
using a BU 110-240 V AC/DC
In this case, the installation guidelines for configuration with the 2nd generation current /
voltage measuring modules must be observed.
See also Configuration information for SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit
(Page 135) for more information.
NOTICE
Rated motor current is in the range from 2.4 - 2.99 A and a 1st generation current / voltage
measuring module with the 2.4 - 25 A measuring range is used
In this case, the 0.3 - 4 A measuring range must be used for the 2nd generation current / voltage
measuring modules.
This requires a change of the parameterization to the smaller measuring range (0.3 - 4 A).
Attention must be paid to this with regard to code conversion of the MLFB numbers.
The installation width of the two measuring ranges is identical.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 125
Description of system components
8.6 Decoupling module (DCM) for 1st generation current/voltage measuring modules (e.g. 3UF711.1AA00-0)
Note
Connectable expansion modules
When using a decoupling module, note that the type and number of expansion modules that
can be connected to a basic unit are limited! See Chapter Configuration information for
SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit (Page 135).
Note
Using the decoupling module
Do not use the decoupling module with the 2nd generation current / voltage measuring
modules.
In the event that a 1st generation current / voltage measuring module is replaced by a
2nd generation current / voltage measuring module, remove the decoupling module.
SIMOCODE pro
126 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.6 Decoupling module (DCM) for 1st generation current/voltage measuring modules (e.g. 3UF711.1AA00-0)
Star networks:
N
PE
R
N
PE
PE
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 127
Description of system components
8.6 Decoupling module (DCM) for 1st generation current/voltage measuring modules (e.g. 3UF711.1AA00-0)
PE
PE
Delta configurations
PE
PE
N
PE
SIMOCODE pro
128 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.7 Spectrum of the expansion modules
Single-phase systems
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 129
Description of system components
8.8 Digital module (DM)
Note
When an operator panel with display and/or a decoupling module is used, you may have to take
further restrictions into consideration concerning the number of expansion modules
connectable per basic unit.
See Chapters Configuration information for SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit
(Page 135) and Configuration notes for use of a SIMOCODE pro V MR and SIMOCODE pro V EIP
basic unit (Page 137)
Up to 2 digital modules can be connected to one SIMOCODE pro basic unit. 4 additional binary
inputs and 2 additional binary outputs are thus provided by each module. All types can be
combined with each other. SIMOCODE pro can therefore be expanded to provide a maximum of
12 binary inputs and 7 relay outputs.
With the monostable version, the relay outputs open after disconnection/failure/interruption of
the supply voltage. With the bistable version, the switching state of the relay outputs is
maintained even after disconnection/failure/interruption of the supply voltage.
You can set a debouncing time for the digital module inputs if required (see Chapter "Digital
module inputs" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958)).
Power supply to the inputs: See Chapter Wiring basic units, expansion modules and the
decoupling module (Page 172).
Note
To implement some motor control functions, a further digital module is required in addition to
the relay outputs on the basic unit.
SIMOCODE pro
130 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.9 Fail-safe digital module (DM-F)
Note
If 2 digital modules are being used, the digital module connected the closest to the basic unit via
the system interface will be identified as digital module 1. The digital module connected next in
line will be identified as digital module 2. If one digital module is connected to the front and
another to the lower system interface of the basic unit, the digital module on the front system
interface of the basic unit will always be identified as digital module 1.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 131
Description of system components
8.10 Analog module (AM)
You can find the manual and operating instructions under Manuals/operating instructions
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man)
The fail-safe DM-F Local digital module facilitates safety-related tripping of a motor feeder by
means of a hardware signal that is detected and evaluated by the module.
From a non-safety-related perspective, the DM-F module comprises:
Table 8-5 Inputs, outputs and voltage supply to the digital module Fail-safe Local (DM‑F Local)
The fail-safe DM-F PROFIsafe digital module provides safety-related tripping of a motor feeder
by a fail-safe control (F-CPU) via PROFIBUS with the fail-safe PROFIsafe profile.
From a non-safety-related perspective, the DM-PROFIsafe module comprises:
Table 8-6 Inputs, outputs and voltage supply to the digital module Fail-safe PROFIsafe
(DM‑F PROFIsafe)
WARNING
Hazardous voltage
For the 24 V DC power supply, always use an SELV or PELV power supply unit!
Surge suppressors are required for inductive loads!
SIMOCODE pro
132 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.11 Ground-fault module (EM)
• For each analog module, 2 analog inputs (passive) for detecting 0/4 mA to 20 mA signals.
Both inputs are set either to 0 mA to 20 mA or to 4 mA to 20 mA.
• For each analog module, 1 output for issuing a 0/4 mA to 20 mA signal.
Note
The inputs of the analog module are passive inputs that have to be supplied in each case by an
external, isolated current source (e.g. isolating transformer). If the output of the analog module
is not being utilized, it can be used as current source for an input.
Note
Requirements for using an analog module with SIMOCODE pro V PB
Use of an analog module requires a SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit, at least version *E02* or
later (from 04/2005).
NOTICE
Use of residual current transformers
The 3UF7 500-1AA00-0 ground-fault module requires the 3UL22 residual current transformer.
The 3UF7 510-1AA00-0 ground-fault module requires the 3UL23 residual current transformer.
Requirements for use of ground-fault modules in combination with SIMOCODE pro V basic
unit:
Note
Requirements for use of a 3UF7 500-1AA00-0 ground-fault module with
SIMOCODE pro V PB
Use of a ground-fault module requires a SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit, at least version *E02*
or later (from 04/2005).
Note
Requirements for use of a 3UF7 510-1AA00-0 ground-fault module with
SIMOCODE pro V PB
Use of this ground-fault module requires a SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit, with at least product
version *E10* (from 09/2013).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 133
Description of system components
8.13 Multifunction module
Note
The same sensor type must be used in all sensor measuring circuits.
• 1 temperature module can be connected to the SIMOCODE pro V PB and pro V MR basic units
• 1 temperature module with 1 sensor to the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
• 2 temperature modules can be connected to the SIMOCODE pro V PN and pro V EIP basic units
• 1 temperature module to the SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic unit
• 3 sensor measuring circuits in 2 or 3-wire systems.
Note
Requirements for using a temperature module with SIMOCODE pro V PB
Use of a temperature module requires a SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit, at least version *E02* or
later (from 04/2005).
SIMOCODE pro
134 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.14 Configuration information for SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit
No more than one multifunction module can be connected to one SIMOCODE pro S basic unit.
Note
Use of expansion modules of SIMOCODE pro V with the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
One of the following expansion modules of SIMOCODE pro V can be used with the
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit (3UF7020-1AB01-0 or 3UF7020-1AU01-0) instead of the 3UF76*
multifunction module:
• 24 V DC digital module with monostable relay outputs (3UF7300-1AB00-0) or
110 ... 240 V AC/DC digital module (3UF7300-1AU00-0)
• Ground-fault module (3UF7510-1AA0-0)
• Temperature module (3UF7700-1AA00-0), limited to use of one sensor input only
Note
Restrictions for the SIMOCODE pro V device series
The restrictions mentioned here apply to the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
with the following product versions:
• SIMOCODE pro V PB: Before E15
• SIMOCODE pro V PN: Before E10
• SIMOCODE pro V MR: Before E03
Devices with the stated product versions or later can be used without restriction with an
operator panel with display and 2nd generation current/voltage measuring modules.
You will find usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display in Chapter Functions
and possible applications of the operator panel with display (Page 79).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 135
Description of system components
8.14 Configuration information for SIMOCODE pro V when using an older basic unit
Table 8-7 Maximum configuration with expansion modules when using an operator panel/operator panel with display, a
1st generation current/voltage measuring module and a decoupling module for SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units
(3UF7010-1A.00-0) with a 24 V DC or 110 V - 240 V AC/DC supply
1) No bistable relay outputs and no more than 5 of 7 relay outputs active simultaneously (> 3 s)
2) No bistable relay outputs and no more than 3 of 5 relay outputs active simultaneously (> 3 s)
3) Analog module output is not used.
4) 1st generation current/voltage measuring modules; MLFB ending in 000
(e.g. 3UF7110-1AA00-0)
5) AM and TM cannot be used at the same time
Table 8-8 Maximum configuration with expansion modules when using an operator panel/operator panel with display, a
2nd generation current/voltage measuring module and a SIMOCODE pro V-PB basic unit with a product version
earlier than E15 / SIMOCODE pro V Modbus basic unit with product version E01
SIMOCODE pro
136 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Description of system components
8.15 Configuration notes for use of a SIMOCODE pro V MR and SIMOCODE pro V EIP basic unit
Note
Decoupling module
A decoupling module is not necessary for 2nd generation current/voltage measuring modules.
Fail-safe digital Number of expansion Digital module 2 Analog module Temperature Ground-fault
module modules module module
DM-F Local max. 4 ✓ ✓ ✓ ✓
DM-F PROFIsafe max. 3 ✓ ✓ ✓ —
Note
Restrictions for the SIMOCODE pro V device series
The restrictions mentioned here apply to the SIMOCODE pro V High Performance device series
with the following product versions:
• SIMOCODE pro V PB: Before E15
• SIMOCODE pro V PN: Before E10
• SIMOCODE pro V MR: Before E03
Devices with the stated product versions or later can be used without restriction with an
operator panel with display and 2nd generation current/voltage measuring modules.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 137
Description of system components
8.15 Configuration notes for use of a SIMOCODE pro V MR and SIMOCODE pro V EIP basic unit
SIMOCODE pro
138 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification 9
9.1 Applications and advantages of compartment identification
The compartment identification described in this chapter is mainly used in application in which
SIMOCODE pro is used in a withdrawable motor control center (MCC).
In withdrawable motor control centers, all components belonging to the motor feeder are
grouped together as one unit in a switchboard-specific enclosure. In this way, a complete
withdrawable module can be replaced very quickly and without isolating the MCC if a
component is defective.
This principle is very often used in the various branches of the process industry. That is why a
SIMOCODE pro with such a design is used in very many of its applications.
With the compartment identification mechanism, programming a SIMOCODE pro S/pro V device
when a withdrawable module is replaced is completely automated.
The initialization module (3UF7 902-0AA00-0) permanently installed in the switchboard
contains a copy of the SIMOCODE device parameters and the device addressing, which are taken
over completely automatically by the new SIMOCODE pro device after replacement of the
withdrawable module.
No special knowledge of SIMOCODE is necessary any longer to replace withdrawable modules
and at the same time the risk of incorrect parameterization in the SIMOCODE device is reduced.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 139
Compartment identification
9.1 Applications and advantages of compartment identification
8)&$ 8)$$
CAUTION
Basic units SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000*) and basic units SIMOCODE pro V (3UF7010*) to
E08, V3.0
These basic units do not support the initialization module and start with the internal
parameters.
SIMOCODE pro
140 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.2 Hardware and software requirements for compartment identification
NOTICE
Basic units SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000*) and basic units SIMOCODE pro V (3UF7010*) to
E08, V3.0
These basic units do not support the initialization module and start with the internal
parameters.
NOTICE
Current measuring module required
To operate SIMOCODE pro with an initialization module, a current measuring module or a
current / voltage measuring module must be connected to the basic unit.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 141
Compartment identification
9.3 Operating compartment identification
Safety guidelines
Note
Startup with an initialization module
During device startup with an initialization module, there must be no memory module in the
system interface of the SIMOCODE basic unit.
If there is a memory module in the system interface of the SIMOCODE pro basic unit,
• the "Fault - parameterization" fault message will be output
• the "Gen.Fault" LED will flash red.
Note
Contacting of the initialization module
The initialization module must be contacted before or together with the voltage supply of the
basic unit.
Note
Loading parameters from the initialization module into the SIMOCODE pro V basic units
with an earlier product version
Basic units SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000*) and SIMOCODE pro V (3UF7010*) to E08, V3.0 do not
detect the initialization module and ignore its parameters!
Note
Connecting a SIMOCODE pro S basic unit or a SIMOCODE pro V basic unit
Because a basic unit in these device series does not find any valid parameters on start-up with
an empty initialization module, "Trip - Parameterization" is signaled. The "general fault" LED of
the basic unit flashes red.
Reparameterization of the device, e.g. with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), writes valid parameters
to the basic unit and the initialization module again.
You can then acknowledge the fault message.
SIMOCODE pro
142 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.3 Operating compartment identification
Note
Device startup when the "initialization module" parameter is activated
If no initialization module is detected during device start-up, SIMOCODE pro will signal "Trip -
Configuration fault." The "General Fault" LED of the basic unit flashes.
The basic unit can only be reset when the configuration error has been remedied by connecting
an initialization module or when a configuration has been loaded into the device without the
"initialization module" option.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 143
Compartment identification
9.3 Operating compartment identification
Commands
Messages
You can check the states of the initialization module by the following events (in the
""Commissioning → Faults, warnings, event" dialog box of the "SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)"
software:
• Initialization module write-protected
• Initialization module write-protected, parameter changes not allowed
• Initialization module identification data write-protected
SIMOCODE pro
144 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.4 Mounting, wiring, interfaces, compartment identification
)DVWHQLQJVWUDS
Figure 9-2 Mounting the initialization module
NOTICE
Note the correct colors!
Incorrect wiring can destroy the initialization module.
Note
Cable routing
When wiring the initialization module make sure the individual conductors are routed as close
together as possible (ribbon cable).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 145
Compartment identification
9.4 Mounting, wiring, interfaces, compartment identification
NOTICE
Maximum length of the connecting cable
The total length of all cables must not exceed 3 m on either of the system interfaces of the basic
unit!
8)&$ 8)$$
2EVHUYHFRORUV
DVUHTXLUHG
CAUTION
SIMOCODE pro basic units with an earlier product version
SIMOCODE pro C basic units (3UF7000*) and SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units (3UF7010*) up
to E08, V3.0 do not support the initialization module and start with the internal parameters.
SIMOCODE pro
146 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.4 Mounting, wiring, interfaces, compartment identification
Connecting the Y connecting cable to the basic unit and to the current measuring module
or to the current / voltage measuring module
• Connect the connector in the middle of the Y connecting cable (1) on the basic unit
• Connect the connector at the end of the Y connecting cable (2) to a current measuring
module or current / voltage measuring module
• If you are using a decoupling module:
– Connect the connector at the end of the initialization cable (2) on the decoupling module.
– Connect the decoupling module with a system interface connecting cable to the current /
voltage measuring module.
Figure 9-4 Connecting the Y connecting cable to the basic unit and to the current measuring module
or to the current / voltage measuring module
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 147
Compartment identification
9.5 Commissioning and service compartment identification
Note
Operating Instructions
During commissioning and service work, also heed the relevant "Initialization Module"
Operating Instructions!
You will find the operating instructions for SIMOCODE pro at Manuals/operating instructions
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man).
Sequence for initial startup of a new SIMOCODE pro basic unit and a new initialization
module
Step Description
1 Connect the SIMOCODE pro basic unit to the planned expansion modules and to the initialization module.
2 Switch on the power supply. The following LED states result:
• The "DEVICE" LED lights up green
• The "BUS" LED lights up or flashes green when the bus is connected
• The "GEN.FAULT" LED flashes red
At the same time, the "Fault - parameterization" fault message is output.
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro with a PC with the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) software installed. For this, connect the
PC/PG to the system interface with the PC cable (see the figure below) or to the basic unit via the communication
bus.
4 Acknowledge the pending fault either locally on the device or via the SIMOCODE ES software by means of the
"TEST/RESET button".
SIMOCODE pro
148 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.7 Compartment identification dimension drawings
Messages
[PP
Figure 9-6 Dimension drawing initialization module
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 149
Compartment identification
9.8 Technical data compartment identification
4 x 1 mm2
SIMOCODE pro
150 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Compartment identification
9.8 Technical data compartment identification
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 151
Compartment identification
9.8 Technical data compartment identification
SIMOCODE pro
152 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Accessories 10
Accessories overview
The following figure shows selected accessories:
,QLWLDOL]DWLRQPRGXOH
&RQQHFWLQJFDEOH
USB PC cable
For device parameterization, for connecting a PC via its USB interface or serial interface to the
system interface of a basic unit.
Note
PC cable variant
For SIMOCODE pro V PN / EIP, a serial PC cable 3UF7940-0AA00-0 as from product version *E02*
or a USB PC cable USB 3UF7941-0AA00-0 can be used.
USB-to-serial adapter
For connecting an RS -232 PC cable to the USB interface of a PC.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 153
Accessories
Memory module
Enable all system parameter settings to be backed up and transferred to a new system without
the need for additional resources or specialist expertise, for example, if the device is replaced
(see also Chapter Replacing SIMOCODE pro components (Page 257)).
Note
Memory module type
• The SIMOCODE pro C and SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units up to product version *E08* only
support the 3UF7900* memory module.
• The SIMOCODE pro S, SIMOCODE pro V MR and SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units support all
memory modules as from product version *E09*.
• A 3UF7901* memory module is required for the SIMOCODE pro V PN and
SIMOCODE pro V EIP basic units. The 3UF7900* memory module is not supported.
Initialization module
The initialization module enables all system parameter settings to be backed up and transferred
to a new system without the need for additional resources or specialist expertise, for example,
if the device is replaced. It can be installed permanently in the switchboard.
Note
Basic unit support
The SIMOCODE pro S and SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units (as from product version *E09*)
support the initialization module.
Addressing plug
For "hardware" assignment of the PROFIBUS DP address without PC/PG on SIMOCODE pro via the
system interface. Setting the PROFIBUS DP address with the addressing plug: See
Chapter Setting the PROFIBUS DP address (Page 236).
Connecting cable
Different types and lengths of connecting cable are available. It is required to connect the basic
unit to its current measuring module and, if applicable, to its expansion modules or the operator
panel.
Note
The total length of all cables must not exceed 3 m on either of the system interfaces of the basic
unit!
SIMOCODE pro
154 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Accessories
Door adapter
The door adapter is used to facilitate access to the SIMOCODE pro system interface, for example
via the front panel, to ensure fast parameterization.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 155
Accessories
SIMOCODE pro
156 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
3UF50 compatibility mode 11
11.1 Application, Win-SIMOCODE-DP converter
Safety guidelines
Note
Communication with a DP master (class 2 master), e.g. with the Win-SIMOCODE-DP Professional
software via PROFIBUS DP, is not covered by the 3UF50 compatibility mode.
Note
In the 3UF50 compatibility mode, the startup parameter block is always set, i.e. the transmission
of the device parameters created using the SIMOCODE-DP GSD or the SIMOCODE-DP Object
Manager cannot be integrated into SIMOCODE pro V PB.
Note
The 3UF50 compatibility mode supports SIMOCODE-DP projects in which SIMOCODE-DP is
integrated via GSD SIEM8031.gs?, SIEM8069.gs? or via the SIMOCODE-DP Object Manager
(OM).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 157
3UF50 compatibility mode
11.2 Diagram of send and receive data
Receive
Basic Basic Basic Basic Basic Basic
type 1, SI‐ type 1, SI‐ type 2, SI‐ type 2, SI‐ type 3, SI‐ type 3, SI‐
MOCODE MO‐ MOCODE MO‐ MOCODE MO‐
DP CODE pro V DP CODE pro V DP CODE pro V
0 Receive da‐ Cyclic re‐ 0 Receive da‐ Cyclic re‐ 0 Receive da‐ Cyclic re‐
1 ta ceive 1 ta ceive 1 ta ceive
bit 0 to 1.7 bit 0 to 1.7 bit 0 to 1.7
2 Not suppor‐ 2 Not suppor‐ 2 Not suppor‐
3 ted 3 ted 3 ted
Send
Basic Basic Basic Basic Basic Basic
type 1, SI‐ type 1, SI‐ type 2, SI‐ type 2, SI‐ type 3, SI‐ type 3, SI‐
MOCODE MO‐ MOCODE MO‐ MOCODE MO‐
DP CODE pro V DP CODE pro V DP CODE pro V
0 Send data Cyclic send 0 Send data Cyclic send 0 Send data Cyclic send
1 bit 0 to 1.7 1 bit 0 to 1.7 1 bit 0 to 1.7
2 Motor cur‐ Specified: 2 Motor cur‐ Specified: 2 Acycl. Send
3 rent max. cur‐ 3 rent max. cur‐ 3 Bit 0 to 1.7
rent Imax rent Imax
4 Number of Specified:
5 starts Number of
starts
6
(Byte 0)
7 Counter 1 Specified:
8 value Counter 1 -
Actual value
9 Counter 2 Specified:
10 value Counter 2 -
Actual value
11 Sensor val‐ Specified:
ue TM - Max.
tempera‐
ture
Note
The send data bytes 2 - 11 are always permanently assigned in compatibility mode (see Table
"'Send' configuration").
SIMOCODE pro
158 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
3UF50 compatibility mode
11.3 Diagram of diagnostics data
Table 11-3 Diagram of the diagnostics data in the 3UF50 compatibility mode
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 159
3UF50 compatibility mode
11.3 Diagram of diagnostics data
SIMOCODE pro
160 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
3UF50 compatibility mode
11.3 Diagram of diagnostics data
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 161
3UF50 compatibility mode
11.3 Diagram of diagnostics data
SIMOCODE pro
162 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting 12
12.1 Mounting
12.1.1 Mounting basic units, expansion modules, and the decoupling module
You can attach these system components as follows:
• Snap-on mounting onto a 35 mm standard mounting rail, without tools
• Snap-on mounting of basic units (no tools required) onto current measuring modules of
45 mm and 55 mm in width (up to 100 A or 115 A (UM+))) with integrated standard
mounting rail
• Screw fixing with fixing lugs (article number: 3RP1903 or 3ZY1311-0AA00 for
SIMOCODE pro S) and screws on a flat surface. These fixing lugs are only suitable for basic
units, expansion modules and the decoupling module!
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 163
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
6FUHZ DWWDFKPHQW
53 53
PP PP
Figure 12-1 Mounting basic unit, expansion modules or the decoupling module, SIMOCODE pro C/V
SIMOCODE pro
164 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
=<$$
Figure 12-2 Mounting of basic unit and multifunction module, SIMOCODE pro S
Sequence for mounting the bus terminal on the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
Proceed as follows:
Table 12-1 Mounting the bus terminal on the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
Step Description
1 Screw the two PROFIBUS cables to the bus terminal as shown
2 Attach the bus terminal to the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit as shown.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 165
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
s
8)$$
*1
5'
FOLF
D
E
Figure 12-3 Mounting the bus terminal on the SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
SIMOCODE pro
166 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
8)$$ $ XS WR $ 8)$$$XSWR$
8)$$ $ XS WR $
6QDSRQ PRXQWLQJ
PP ZLGWK PP ZLGWK
6FUHZ DWWDFKPHQW
59% PP VSDFHU 59%
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 167
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
Note
Current / voltage measuring modules with a current setting of up to 115 A can be connected to
the basic unit mechanically and installed as a unit (behind one another).
Larger current / voltage measuring modules can only be mounted separately.
ZLGWK PP ZLGWK PP
PP VSDFHU
59% 59%
VFUHZPRXQWLQJ
Figure 12-5 Mounting the current / voltage measuring modules UM+ with through-hole technology
SIMOCODE pro
168 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
PP ZLGWK PP ZLGWK
6FUHZ DWWDFKPHQW
59% PP VSDFHU 59%
Figure 12-6 Mounting the current / voltage measuring modules UM with through-hole technology
Figure 12-7 Mounting the current / voltage measuring modules UM with bus connection system
12.1.6 Mounting of the operator panel and operator panel with display
The operator panels are designed for installation in the front panels of motor control centers, for
example, or in control cabinet doors.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 169
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
Table 12-2 Sequence for installing the operator panel / operator panel with display
Step Description
1 Make a cutout, e.g. in the front panel or switchgear cabinet door. Dimensions (see figure
"Mounting the operator panel" or figure "Mounting the operator panel with display").
2 Position the operator panel or the operator panel with display in the cutout.
3 Snap the four mounting brackets onto the operator panel.
4 Lock the operator panel in position by tightening the four screws on the securing brackets.
&XWRXW
)URQW SDQHO
VZLWFKJHDU
FDELQHW GRRU
HWF
SIMOCODE pro
170 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.1 Mounting
&XWRXW
)URQW SDQHO
VZLWFKJHDU FDELQHW GRRU
HWF
WARNING
Tightening torque of the screws
To ensure that the panel will function correctly and is sealed to comply with IP54, the tightening
torque of the screws provided must not be set too high when mounting and the seal must be
properly fitted.
Note
Only one connecting cable is required for connecting the operator panel with display to
SIMOCODE pro (see Chapter An overview of system components (Page 57)). Additional wiring
for the power supply or ground is not required.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 171
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
12.2.1 Wiring basic units, expansion modules and the decoupling module
Removable terminals
Basic units, expansion modules and the decoupling module have removable terminals. You do
not have to detach the wiring to exchange these devices!
5HPRYDEOH WHUPLQDOV
%DVLF XQLWV ([SDQVLRQ PRGXOHV
GHFRXSOLQJ PRGXOH
' '
& &
$ $
$ & ' &RGLQJ
Figure 12-10 Removable terminals for basic units, expansion modules, or the decoupling module,
SIMOCODE pro C/V
Note
The removable terminals are mechanically coded and will only fit in a certain position!
SIMOCODE pro
172 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
8 9
DEFG
Figure 12-11 Removable terminals for SIMOCODE pro C and pro V basic units
2
1
2 1
Figure 12-12 Removable terminals for basic unit and multifunction module, SIMOCODE pro S
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 173
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
'
' &
&
$ $
Figure 12-13 Removable terminals for SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V EIP basic units, expansion modules
and decoupling module
Cables
The conductor cross sections are the same for all devices. The following table shows conductor
cross sections, stripped lengths, and tightening torques of the cables for the removable
terminals:
Table 12-3 Conductor cross sections, stripped lengths, and tightening torques of the cables for the basic units
SIMOCODE pro C and pro V
SIMOCODE pro
174 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Table 12-4 Conductor cross sections, stripped lengths, and tightening torques of the cables for the basic unit SIMOCODE pro S
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals 287 ,1 ,1 7
1 Common potential for relay outputs 1 and 2
2 Relay output OUT1
287 9 ,1 ,1 7
3 Relay output OUT2
4 Digital input IN3 ˽
5 Digital input IN4
6,02&2'( 352
T2 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
6 Relay output OUT3
7 Relay output OUT3 '(9,&(
8 24 V DC only for IN1 to IN4 %86
9 Digital input IN1
*(1)$8/7
10 Digital input IN2
T1 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
Lower terminals
352),%86'3
7(67
A1 Supply voltage terminal 1
5(6(7
A2 Supply voltage terminal 2
A Bus-type connection A
B Bus-type connection B
SPE 1)
System shielding
$ $ $ % 63(
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 175
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
176 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
IN+ 24 V DC only for IN1 to IN4
A1 Supply voltage terminal 1
A2 Supply voltage terminal 2
A PROFIBUS DP terminal A
B PROFIBUS DP terminal B
SPE 1) System shielding
IN1 Digital input IN1
IN2 Digital input IN2
IN3 Digital input IN3
Lower terminals
T1 Thermistor connection 1 (binary PTC)
T2 Thermistor connection 2 (binary PTC)
IN4 Digital input IN4
13 Common potential for relay outputs 1
and 2
14 Relay output OUT1
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 177
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
The technical data for protection when using an external power supply can be found in Siemens
Industry Online Support (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16337/td).
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
1 Common potential for relay out‐
puts 1 and 2
287 ,1 ,1 7 287 ,1 ,1 7
2 Relay output OUT1
3 Relay output OUT2
4 Digital input IN3 287 9 ,1 ,1 7 287 9 ,1 ,1 7
5 Digital input IN4
T2 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
6 Relay output OUT3 6,02&2'(352931*3 6,02&2'(352931*3
7 Relay output OUT3
8 24 V DC only for IN1 to IN4 '(9,&( !V '(9,&( !V
8)
8)
9 Digital input IN1 %86 V %86 V
10 Digital input IN2 *(1)$8/7 *(1)$8/7
T1 Thermistor connection (binary PTC) 3257 3257
Lower terminals 3257 3257
A1 Supply voltage terminal 1 7(67 7(67
A2 Supply voltage terminal 2 5(6(7 5(6(7
31/$1
31/$1
$ $ 63( $ $ 63(
SIMOCODE pro
178 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
2)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
A1 / A2 supply voltage:
The technical data for protection can be found in Siemens Industry Online Support (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16337/td).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 179
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals 287 ,1 ,1 7
1 Common potential for relay outputs 1 and 2
2 Relay output OUT1
287 9 ,1 ,1 7
3 Relay output OUT2
4 Digital input IN3
5 Digital input IN4
6,02&2'(352931
T2 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
6 Relay output OUT3
'(9,&( !V
7 Relay output OUT3
8)
%86 V
8 24 V DC only for IN1 to IN4
*(1)$8/7
9 Digital input IN1
3257
10 Digital input IN2
3257
T1 Thermistor connection (binary PTC)
Lower terminals 7(67
5(6(7
A1 Supply voltage terminal 1
31/$1
A2 Supply voltage terminal 2
PORT 1 PROFINET / EIP connection 1
PORT 2 PROFINET / EIP connection 2
SPE 1) System shielding
$ $ 63(
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
180 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
D E F
9'&LQWHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH 9'&H[WHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH 9'&H[WHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH
,1
,1 ,1
,1 ,1
FDQQRWEHXVHG ,1
,1 ,1
,1
$
9 '&
$
2QO\SRVVLEOHIRUEDVLFXQLWZLWK9'&
VXSSO\YROWDJH
Figure 12-14 24 V DC to supply the inputs and SIMOCODE pro C / pro V PB / pro V MB RTU / pro S basic
units
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 181
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
D E F
9'&LQWHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH 9'&H[WHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH 9'&H[WHUQDOLQSXWVXVDEOH
,1 ,1 ,1
FDQQRWEHXVHG
,1 ,1 ,1
,1 ,1 ,1
,1
,1 ,1
$
9 '&
$
2QO\SRVVLEOHIRUEDVLFXQLWZLWK9'&
VXSSO\YROWDJH
Figure 12-15 24 V DC to supply the inputs, SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V EIP / pro V PN GP basic units
All inputs work reaction-free, i.e. the signal statuses on neighboring inputs do not influence
each other.
Wiring sequence of the removable terminal of the SIMOCODE pro C/V basic units
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 Connect the cables to the upper and lower terminals.
2 If you wish to use the A/B terminals for PROFIBUS DP, connect the PROFIBUS DP cable shield to the SPE / PE terminal.
3 Connect the equipment shield to the SPE 1) terminal.
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
Note
The A / B terminals are an alternative to the 9-way SUB-D connection! Baud rates of up to
1.5 Mbit / s 1) are possible.
Note
1) Baud rates > 1.5 Mbit / s
At baud rates > 1.5 Mbit / s, the "Bus" fault is generated and the "Bus" LED lights up.
SIMOCODE pro
182 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Wiring sequence of the PROFIBUS cable for SIMOCODE pro S basic units
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 Insulate the PROFIBUS cable as shown below.
2 Screw the SPE cable to the bus terminal as shown below.
3 Connect the PROFIBUS cables A and B and the SPE cable to terminals A, B, and SPE 1) as shown below.
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
CAUTION
SPE connection
Connect the SPE cable to the SPE terminal or alternatively to the bus connection terminal with
a ring cable lug.
10 +1 37 ±3 10
1
2
Figure 12-16 Wiring sequence of the PROFIBUS cable for SIMOCODE pro S basic units
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 183
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Sequence for wiring the removable terminals for SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V EIP / pro V PN GP basic
units
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 Connect the cables to the upper and lower terminals.
2 Connect the equipment shield to the SPE 1) terminal.
DANGER
Hazardous voltage. Can cause death or serious injury
To ensure touch protection and degree of protection IP20 for SIMOCODE pro S, screw in all
screws which are not used for conductor clamping and close the terminal covers.
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
184 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
E
37& D
7 7
,1 ,1 ,1 ,1 9
287
'HYLFH
287
%XV
*HQ )DXOW
287
352),%86 '3
$ $ $ % 63(
PD[ 0%G
9'&
99$&'&
Figure 12-17 Connection example SIMOCODE pro C / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 185
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
E
37& D
7 7
,1 ,1 ,1 ,1 ,1
9
287
'HYLFH
287
%XV
*HQ )DXOW
352),%86 '3
$
$ $ % 63(
9'& 0D[ 0%G
99$&'&
Note
Only three inputs can be used
With an external 24 V DC supply, only three inputs can be used (see section "Power supply to the
inputs of the basic unit" above).
Note
Baud rates PROFIBUS DP
Baud rates up to 1.5 Mbits are possible via bus terminals A/B.
SIMOCODE pro
186 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
37&
D
7 7
,1 ,1 ,1 ,1 9
'(9,&(
287
%86
287
*(1)$8/7
3257
3257
287
$ $ 63(
9'&
99$&'&
Figure 12-19 Connection examples for SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V EIP basic units
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 187
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
287
20 Common potential for relay outputs 1 and 2
21 Relay output OUT1
22 Relay output OUT2 ,1 ,1
5($'<
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
188 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
The technical data for protection can be found in Siemens Industry Online Support (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16337/td).
,1 ,1
,1 ,1
,1 ,1
a $&
'&
ದ
,1 ,1 ,1 ,1 10
5HDG\
287
287
63(
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 189
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
IN1 Digital input IN1
IN2 Digital input IN2
IN3 Digital input IN3
SPE 1) System shielding
IN- Ground for IN1 to IN4
IN4 Digital input IN4
C1 Terminal 1, 3UL23 residual current trans‐
former
C2 Terminal 2, 3UL23 residual current trans‐
former
Lower terminals
T1 Input T1, temperature sensor
T2 Input T2, temperature sensor
T3 Input T3, temperature sensor
13 Common potential for relay outputs 1 and 2
14 Relay output OUT1
24 Relay output OUT2
DANGER
Hazardous voltage. Can cause death or serious injury
To ensure touch protection and degree of protection IP20 for SIMOCODE pro S, screw in all
screws which are not used for conductor clamping and close the terminal covers.
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
190 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
/
/
/
1
∼ $&
'&
287
5HDG\
& 287
8/
&
63(
7 7 7 63(
ϑ ZLUHWHPSHUDWXUHVHQVRUV
ZLUHWHPSHUDWXUHVHQVRUV
6KLHOGHGFDEOHUHFRPPHQGHG
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 191
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
NOTICE
Routing the connecting cables / using shielded cables
To avoid interference injection, which could result in incorrect measurements, route these
connecting lines parallel and twisted, if possible, or use shielded cables.
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
&
40 Input C1 residual current transformer
43 Input C2 residual current transformer
Lower terminals &
SPE 1) System shielding
5($'<
(0
8)ದ$$ದ
*<<00'' ([[
63(
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
192 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
NOTICE
Types of ground-fault module
The 3UF7 500-1AA00-0 ground-fault module requires the 3UL22 residual current transformer.
The 3UF7 510-1AA00-0 ground-fault module requires the 3UL23 residual current transformer.
/
/
/
1
=
8/RU8/
=
&DEOH VKLHOGLQJ UHFRPPHQGHG
& &
5HDG\
63(
The output signal of the transformers 3UL22/3UL23 is connected to terminals C1 and C2 of the
corresponding ground-fault module.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 193
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Information on installing the residual current transformer 3UL23: See Manual 3UG4/3RR2
Monitoring Relay (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/54397927), Chapter
13.2.5.
NOTICE
Routing the connecting cables / using shielded cables
To avoid interference injection, which could result in incorrect measurements, route these
connecting lines parallel and twisted, if possible, or use shielded cables.
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
777
50 Input T3, temperature sensor 1
51 Input T3, temperature sensor 2
52 Input T3, temperature sensor 3 777
53 Input T2, temperature sensor 1
54 Input T2, temperature sensor 2
55 Input T2, temperature sensor 3
Lower terminals
56 Input T1, temperature sensor 1 to 3
57 Input T1, temperature sensor 1 to 3
SPE 1)
System shielding
5($'<
70
8)ದ$$ದ
*<<00'' ([[
7 63(
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
194 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
[ PD[ [ PD[
˽ ˽
&DEOH VKLHOGLQJ UHFRPPHQGHG
5HDG\
7 7
63(
-
Figure 12-24 Temperature module connection example
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 195
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
,1 ,1
30 Analog input IN1+
31 Analog input IN2+
33 Analog input IN1+ ,1 ,1
34 Analog input IN2+
Lower terminals
36 Analog output OUT+
37 Analog output OUT+
SPE 1) System shielding
5($'<
$0
8)ದ$$ದ
*<<00'' ([[
287 63(
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
196 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
,1 ,1
,1 ,1
5HDG\
287 287
63(
&DEOH VKLHOGLQJ UHFRPPHQGHG IRU XS WR P
DQG IRU RXWVLGH RI WKH VZLWFKJHDU FDELQHW
&DEOH VKLHOGLQJ QHFHVVDU\ IRU RYHU P
5/
, 287 $ P$
5/ 2KP
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 197
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
—
Lower terminals
SPE 1) System shielding
5($'<
'&0
8)ದ$$ದ
*<<00'' ([[
63(
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
5HDG\
SIMOCODE pro
198 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Wiring the removable terminals of the expansion modules and the decoupling module
Connect the equipment shield to the SPE terminal.
Safety guidelines
See Manual Fail-safe Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (https://support.automation.siemens.com/
WW/view/en/50564852), Chapter "Mounting and connection."
WARNING
Loss of safety function is possible
For the 24 V DC power supply, always use an SELV or PELV power supply unit!
Note
Surge suppressors are required for inductive loads.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 199
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Table 12-5 Terminal assignment of the removable terminals of the digital module DM-F Local, 24 V DC
version and 110 to 240 V UC version.
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
60, 66 Digital module, relay outputs 1 (60)
and 2 (66)
61, 67 Relay enabling circuit 1, NO
62, 68 Relay enabling circuit 2, NO
Y12, Y22 Sensor input channel 1, channel 2
T1, T2 Supply for sensor inputs (24 V DC,
pulsed)
Y33 Start button (start after rising and fall‐
ing edge)
Y34 Feedback circuit
Lower terminals
A1 (+) Power supply connection 110 to
240 V AC/DC or +24 V DC
A2 (-) N or -24 V
M Ground (reference potential for sen‐
sor inputs, 3UF7320-1AU00-0 only)
1 Cascading input
T3 Supply for sensor inputs (24 V DC,
static)
SPE 1) System shielding
SIMOCODE pro
200 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
1: Cascading input:
No additional measures are required for short-circuit protection.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 201
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Table 12-6 Terminal assignment of the removable terminals of the digital module DM-F PROFIsafe,
24 V DC version and 110 to 240 V UC version.
Terminal Assignment
Upper terminals
80, 86 Digital module, relay outputs 1 (80)
and 2 (86)
81, 87 Relay enabling circuit 1, NO
82, 88 Relay enabling circuit 2, NO
83 (IN1) Digital module, inputs 1, 2, 3
85 (IN2)
89 (IN3)
84 Power supply, diigital module, inputs
1 to 3, 24 V DC
90 (T) Feedback circuit supply (FBC) 24 V DC
91 (FBC) Feedback circuit
Lower terminals
A1 (+) Power supply connection 110 to
240 V AC/DC or +24 V DC
A2 (-) N or -24 V
M Ground (reference potential inputs,
only 3UF7320‑1AU00-0)
1 Cascading input
T3 Supply for sensor inputs (24 V DC,
static)
SPE 1) System shielding
1)
Note
Connect SIMOCODE pro via terminal SPE with the maximum possible cross-section and with as
short a cable as possible to the functional ground of the control cabinet, e.g. to the grounded
mounting plate of the control cabinet.
SIMOCODE pro
202 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
1: Cascading input:
No additional measures are required for short-circuit protection.
WARNING
Fuse protection required!
Always install the prescribed fuse protection.
This ensures safe tripping in the event of a fault.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 203
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
1(2=('$J/J*6(
&ODVV&&$TXLFNUHVSRQVH
4 1:+*
67$57
4
5($'<
&+
'(9,&(
287
,1
6DIHW\/RJLF
6) &+
287
'LJLWDO0RGXOH2XWSXW
287
$ $ 63(
/ 1
4 4 4 4
Figure 12-27 Connection example for "DM-F Local with cross-circuit detection, 2 NCs, 2 channels,
monitored start"
For further connection examples: See Manual Fail-safe Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852).
WARNING
Fuse protection required!
Always install the prescribed fuse protection.
This ensures safe tripping in the event of a fault.
SIMOCODE pro
204 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
4 1(2=('$J/J*6(
&ODVV&&$TXLFNUHVSRQVH
67$57 1:+*
4
0
5($'<
&+
'(9,&(
287 6DIHW\/RJLF
6) &+
287
'LJLWDO0RGXOH2XWSXW
287
$ $ 63(
/ 1
4 4 4 4
Selection
Select the appropriate current measuring module according to the motor current:
• Through-hole connection up to 200 A: The cables of the three phases are passed through the
feed-through openings.
• Bus connection system from 20 A to 630 A, also for direct connection to Siemens contactors.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 205
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
3UF7104-1BA00-0; 63 to 630 A
Conductor cross section: 50 to 240 mm²,
AWG 1/0 to 500 kcmil
L1
L2
L3
N
L1 L2 L3
T1 T2 T3
M
3~
SIMOCODE pro
206 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Note
When connecting or routing the cables of the individual phases of the main circuit, ensure
correct assignment of the phases on the current measuring module and correct routing
direction!
Please note the information in the Operating Instructions. You will also find the Operating
Instructions for SIMOCODE pro at Operating instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man)
Selection
Select the appropriate current / voltage measuring module according to the motor current.
• Through-hole connection up to 200 A: The cables of the three phases are passed through the
feed-through openings.
• Bus connection system from 20 A to 630 A, also for direct connection to Siemens contactors.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 207
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
The following table shows the various current / voltage measuring modules:
1) 3UF7113-1AA00-0; 20 - 200 A
2) 3UF7113-1AA01-0; 20 - 200 A
3) 3UF7123-1AA01-0; 20 - 200 A
Ø feed-through openings: 25 mm
1) 3UF7113-1BA00-0; 20 - 200 A Bus connection system
2) 3UF7113-1BA01-0; 20 - 200 A
3) 3UF7123-1BA01-0; 20 - 200 A
Conductor cross section: 16 to 95 mm²,
AWG 5 to 3/0
1) 3UF7114-1BA00-0; 63 - 630 A
2) 3UF7114-1BA01-0; 63 - 630 A
3) 3UF7124-1BA01-0; 63 - 630 A
Conductor cross section: 50 to 240 mm²,
AWG 1/0 to 500 kcmil
SIMOCODE pro
208 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
L1
L2
L3
N
L1 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3
T1 T2 T3
M
3~
Safety guidelines
WARNING
1) Short-circuit proof wiring or line protection recommended
Note
Acquisition of the line supply voltage
A voltage tap between the circuit breaker or fuse and the contactor is recommended for
acquisition of the line supply voltage.
Thus, when the motor is shut down, its operable state can be derived from the presence of the
supply voltage.
Note
Measurement of voltage or power-related variables
Connect the main circuit L1, L2, L3 of a current / voltage measuring module to the clamps (L1,
L2, L3) of the removable terminal with a 3-core cable. The supply cables may require additional
cable protection, for example via short-circuit proof cable or fuses.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 209
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Note
When connecting or routing the cables of the individual phases of the main circuit, ensure
correct assignment of the phases on the current / voltage measuring module and correct routing
direction!
Please note the information in the Operating Instructions. You will also find the Operating
Instructions for SIMOCODE pro at Operating instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man)
Removable terminals
The following tables show conductor cross-sections, stripped lengths, tightening torques of
conductors and pin assignments of the removable terminals of the current / voltage measuring
modules:
Table 12-9 Conductor cross-sections, stripped lengths, tightening torques of conductors of the 2nd generation 45 mm and
55 mm current / voltage measuring modules
Table 12-10 Conductor cross-sections, stripped lengths, tightening torques of conductors of the 2nd generation 120 mm and
145 mm current / voltage measuring modules
SIMOCODE pro
210 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Pin assignments of the removable terminals of the 2nd generation current / voltage
measuring modules
L1, L2, L3: Terminals for connecting the 3-wire cable of the main circuit
Table 12-11 Conductor cross-sections, stripped lengths, tightening torques of conductors of the 1st generation current /
voltage measuring modules
Pin assignments of the removable terminals of the 1st generation current / voltage
measuring modules
%RWWRP 8SSHU
L1, L2, L3: Terminals for connecting the 3-wire cable of the main circuit
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 211
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Functional principle
SIMOCODE pro can be operated with external current transformers. The secondary cables of the
current transformer are looped through the three feed-through openings of the current
measuring module, and short-circuited. The secondary current of the external current
transformer is the primary current of the SIMOCODE pro current measuring module.
Note
If the main circuit is using rated current, the secondary current of the current transformer must
be within the setting range of the current measuring module used!
.
.
&XUUHQW PHDVXULQJ %DVLF XQLW
. PRGXOH 8) 8)
/
Transformation ratio
The transformation ratio is calculated using the following formula:
In the following examples, the displayed actual current flowing does not need to be converted,
even when an interposing transformer is used, since SIMOCODE pro only outputs the
proportional value, based upon the parameterized current setting Is.
SIMOCODE pro
212 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
• Transformer rating: Recommended ≥ 2.5 VA, depending on the secondary current and cable
length
• Overcurrent factor: 5P10 or 10P10
• Accuracy class: 1
Example 1
• 3UF1868-3GA00 current transformer:
– Primary current: 820 A at nominal load
– Secondary current: 1 A
• SIMOCODE pro with 3UF7100-1AA00-0 current measuring module, current setting
0.3 A to 3 A. This means:
– The secondary current of the current transformer is 1 A at rated load and is, therefore,
within the 0.3 to 3 A setting range of the current measuring module used
– The current setting Is to be parameterized in SIMOCODE pro is 1 A.
.
&XUUHQW PHDVXULQJ
.
PRGXOH 8) %DVLF XQLW
. $GMXVWPHQW UDQJH 8)
/ $ $
Figure 12-31 Example (1 of 2) for measuring current with an 3UF18 external current transformer
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 213
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.2 Wiring, connecting
Example 2
• 3UF1868-3GA00 current transformer:
– Primary current: 205 A at nominal load
– Secondary current: 0.25 A
• SIMOCODE pro with 3UF7100-1AA00-0 current measuring module, current setting 0.3 to 3
A. This means:
– The secondary current of the current transformer is 0.25 A at rated load and is,
therefore, not within the 0.3 to 3 A setting range of the current measuring module used.
– The secondary current must be boosted by multiple looping of the secondary cables
through the feed-through openings of the current measuring module. Double-looping
results in 2 x 0.25 A = 0.5 A.
– The current setting Is to be parameterized in SIMOCODE pro is 0.5 A.
.
&XUUHQW PHDVXULQJ
.
PRGXOH 8) %DVLF XQLW
. $GMXVWPHQW UDQJH 8)
/ $ $
Figure 12-32 Example (2 of 2) for measuring current with an external 3UF18 current transformer
Note
If the SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit as from version *E03* is used, the current setting does not
have to be converted but is the same as the nominal primary current.
By additionally entering the transformation ratio of the current transformer (interposing
transformer), conversion will be performed automatically in the device.
SIMOCODE pro
214 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
WARNING
Hazardous voltage
Connect the system interfaces only when they are fully de-energized!
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 215
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
See also
Closing the system interfaces with the system interface cover (Page 225)
Examples of connection of system components to the system interface and system structure
Close system interfaces not in use with the system interface cover (see Closing the system
interfaces with the system interface cover (Page 225).
WARNING
System interface on the operator panels (degree of protection IP54):
To ensure degree of protection IP 54
• press the cover into the socket as far as it will go when it is used for the first time!
• When fastening the operator panel with the screws supplied, do not apply an excessive
tightening torque.
The following figure shows an example for SIMOCODE pro C/V of connecting system
components to the
system interfaces:
SIMOCODE pro
216 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
2XWJRLQJ WR 2XWJRLQJ WR
ವ H[SDQVLRQ PRGXOHRQO\SUR9 ವ H[SDQVLRQ PRGXOH
ವ RSHUDWRU SDQHO ವ RSHUDWRU SDQHO
&RQQHFWLRQPHPRU\PRGXOHDGGUHVVLQJSOXJ3&FDEOH &RQQHFWLRQPHPRU\PRGXOHDGGUHVVLQJSOXJ
3&FDEOH
'LJLWDOPRGXOHV'0) /RFDO 'HFRXSOLQJPRGXOH'&0
'0) 352),VDIH
,QFRPLQJ IURP
ವ H[SDQVLRQ PRGXOH
,QFRPLQJ IURP
ವ EDVLF XQLWSUR9
ವ H[SDQVLRQ PRGXOH
ವ EDVLF XQLWSUR9
,QFRPLQJ IURP
EDVLFXQLWSUR9
Figure 12-33 Example of system interfaces - SIMOCODE pro C/V with system component IM, UM+
The following figure shows an example for SIMOCODE pro S of connecting system components
to the system interfaces:
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 217
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
2SHUDWRUSDQHO23
SIMOCODE pro
218 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
2SHUDWRUSDQHO23
Step Description
1 Place the plug in the plug shaft, keeping it is as straight as possible. Ensure the locking
mechanisms of the connector slot audibly snap onto the connector enclosure.
2 System interfaces not in use can be closed using the system interface cover.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 219
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
&DWFKHV &RORUFRGLQJ
6\VWHPLQWHUIDFHVRQWKH
IURQWVLGHDQERWWRP &DWFKHV
([DPSOH6,02&2'( SUR 6
&DWFKHV &RORUFRGLQJ
6\VWHPLQWHUIDFHFRYHU
6\VWHPLQWHUIDFHVRQWKH &DWFKHV
IURQWVLGH
Figure 12-37 Sequence for connecting cables to the system interfaces
Safety guidelines
Note
Only a current / voltage measuring module may be connected to the right-hand system interface
of the decoupling module. Memory modules, addressing plugs or PC cables will not be
recognized there.
Note
Observe the color coding of the connecting cable (see diagram)!
SIMOCODE pro
220 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
12.3.3 System interfaces on the digital modules DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe
See System Manual SIMOCODE pro fail-safe digital modules (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852), Chapter "Mounting and
connection."
12.3.4 System interfaces on the operator panel and the operator panel with display
WARNING
Hazardous voltage
Connect the system interfaces only when they are fully de-energized!
WARNING
System interface on the operator panels (degree of protection IP54):
To ensure degree of protection IP 54
• press the cover into the socket as far as it will go when it is used for the first time!
• When fastening the operator panel with the screws supplied, do not apply an excessive
tightening torque.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 221
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
Sequence for connecting cables to the system interface of the operator panel and the operator
panel with display
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 Place the plug in the plug shaft, keeping it is as straight as possible. Ensure the locking
mechanisms of the connector slot audibly snap onto the connector enclosure.
The incoming connecting cable is connected on the rear.
2 System interfaces not in use can be closed using the system interface cover.
Note
Throughout connection, you can place the cover on one of the two "park positions" (see figure
below).
Note
Observe the color coding of the connecting cable (see diagram)!
SIMOCODE pro
222 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
)URQW
5HDU
&DWFKHV
&DWFKHV
&RORU FRGLQJ
&RQQHFWLQJ FDEOH
Figure 12-38 Sequence for connecting cables to the system interface of the operator panel
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 223
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
)URQW
&RYHU
3DUN SRVLWLRQ
5HDU
Figure 12-39 Sequence for connecting cables to the system interface of the operator panel with display
SIMOCODE pro
224 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
12.3.5 Closing the system interfaces with the system interface cover
Examples of closing the system interface with the system interface cover
Figure 12-40 Examples of closing the system interface with the system interface cover
WARNING
System interface on the operator panels (degree of protection IP54):
To ensure degree of protection IP 54
• press the cover into the socket as far as it will go when it is used for the first time!
• When fastening the operator panel with the screws supplied, do not apply an excessive
tightening torque.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 225
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
PROFIBUS DP connection
The PROFIBUS DP can be connected to the basic unit.
Note
The 9-way SUB-D connection is an alternative to the A / B terminals!
Sequence for connecting PROFIBUS DP to the SIMOCODE pro C and SIMOCODE pro V basic units
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 Connect the PROFIBUS DP cable with the 9-pole SUB-D plug to the PROFIBUS DP interface.
SROH
68%' SOXJ
SIMOCODE pro
226 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
NOTICE
Ethernet connector
Connect using only Industrial Ethernet connectors, e.g.
• Siemens IE FC RJ45 PLUG 180 2x2, RJ45 connector (10/100MBIT/S) with robust metal
housing and Fast Connect connection method, for IE FC Cable 2x2 180° cable outlet, order
number 6GK1901-1BB10-2AA0 or
• Siemens IE FC RJ45 PLUG 90 2x2, RJ45 connector (10/100MBIT/S) with robust metal
housing and Fast Connect connection method, for IE FC Cable 2x2 90° cable outlet, order
number 6GK1901-1BB20-2AA0.
Table 12-15 Connecting the ETHERNET cable to the basic unit pro V
Step Description
1 Connect the Ethernet cable to the Ethernet interface 1 and/or Ethernet interface 2
Figure 12-42 Connecting the Ethernet cable to the basic unit pro V
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 227
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.3 System interfaces
NOTICE
9-pin sub-D connection
The 9-way sub-D connection is an alternative to the A/B terminals!
Connecting Modbus RTU to the SIMOCODE pro V Modbus basic unit via the device terminals
Terminal assignment:
Connecting Modbus RTU to the SIMOCODE pro V Modbus basic unit via the sub-D connector
The pin assignments of the 9-pin sub-D socket for SIMOCODE pro correspond to the assignments
defined for PROFIBUS DP. The sub-D connector has the following assignments:
SIMOCODE pro
228 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.4 Configuration guidelines
Figure 12-43 Connecting the 9-pin sub-D connector to the SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU basic unit
NOTICE
Using the PROFIBUS DP connector
When the PROFIBUS DP connector is used, the bus terminator does not conform to the Modbus
specification.
Possible functional constraints resulting from the use of the PROFIBUS DP bus terminator with
a MODBUS TCP are the user's responsibility.
You can find recommendations for a suitable layout of the serial communication bus in the
document MODBUS over Serial Line - Specification and Implementation Guide - V1.02 (http://
www.modbus.org/docs/Modbus_over_serial_line_V1_02.pdf) on the Internet.
Definition
The key data contained in this chapter is valid for Siemens products and cables.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 229
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.4 Configuration guidelines
Publisher:
PROFIBUS-Nutzerorganisation e. V.
Haid-und-Neu-Strasse 7
76131 Karlsruhe / Germany
Phone: ++49 721 965 85 90
Fax: ++49 721 965 85 89
Internet: PROFIBUS user organization (http://www.profibus.com)
Guideline: Order no. 2.111
See also Manual "SIMATIC NET PROFIBUS Networks (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/1971286)."
Note
Use of SIMOCODE pro S basic units
In particular, when using SIMOCODE pro S basic units, use the bus termination module for
connecting a PROFIBUS segments.
SIMOCODE pro
230 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.4 Configuration guidelines
Publisher:
PROFIBUS-Nutzerorganisation e. V.
Haid-und-Neu-Strasse 7
76131 Karlsruhe / Germany
Phone: +49 (721) 965-8590
Fax: +49 (721) 965-8589
Internet: PI - PROFIBUS & PROFINET International Home (http://www.profibus.com)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 231
Mounting, wiring, connecting
12.4 Configuration guidelines
• PROFINET commissioning
Version: 1.01
Order No.: 8.081
Language: German
• PROFINET commissioning
Checklist version: 1.01
Order No.: 8.091
Language: German
For an overview of the structure and configuration of Industrial Ethernet networks with
SIMATIC NET: See also "Industrial Ethernet Networking Manual" system manual (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/27069465)
SIMOCODE pro
232 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting 13
13.1 General information about commissioning and service
Safety guidelines
WARNING
Hazardous voltage!
Can cause electric shock and burns.
Before starting work, disconnect the system and the device from the power supply.
Note
Please also observe the following SIMOCODE pro Operating Instructions (supplied with the
devices):
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 233
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.1 General information about commissioning and service
Prerequisites
The following prerequisites must be fulfilled for commissioning and servicing:
• SIMOCODE pro is already installed and wired
• The motor is switched off.
Parameterization methods
You can parameterize SIMOCODE pro as follows:
• With the memory module in which the parameters have already been saved from a basic unit.
The memory module is plugged into the system interface. If the memory module is
connected to the system interface and the supply voltage returns to the basic unit, the basic
unit will be automatically parameterized by the memory module. The parameters can also be
downloaded to the basic unit from the memory module by pressing the TEST / RESET button
briefly.
• With the SIMOCODE ES software via serial or USB interface: The PC / PG is connected to the
system interface with a PC cable.
• With an automation system and/or SIMOCODE ES software via PROFIBUS DP. For this purpose,
the PROFIBUS DP cable is connected to the PROFIBUS DP interface of the basic unit.
• With the initialization module in which the parameters have already been saved from a basic
unit. The initialization module is permanently installed in the switchboard in a Motor
Control Center (MCC). If a withdrawable unit with a SIMOCODE pro S or SIMOCODE pro V
basic unit into the MCC and the power supply returns to the basic unit, it will automatically
be parameterized by the initialization module.
Commissioning options
There are two commissioning options:
1. Standard case: SIMOCODE pro has not yet been parameterized and has the factory setting
2. SIMOCODE pro has already been parameterized:
– The parameters have already been loaded into the basic unit.
– The parameters from a previous application still exist. Check whether the parameters
(e.g. the set current) are correct for the new application. Change these accordingly, if
necessary.
SIMOCODE pro
234 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
1 Switch on the power supply. In a fault-free state, the following LEDS should light up or flash green:
• "Device" (lights up)
• "Bus" if PROFIBUS DP is connected (lights up or flashes).
Proceed to Step 2.
Otherwise, carry out diagnostics according to the LED display. For more information, see Chapter Diagnostics
via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel (PROFIBUS) (Page 238). Try to rectify the fault.
2 If you wish to make SIMOCODE pro available on the PROFIBUS DP, set the PROFIBUS DP address. For more
information, see Chapter Setting the PROFIBUS DP address (Page 236).
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro or check the existing parameterization, e.g. with a PC on which SIMO‐
CODE ES (TIA Portal) software is installed. For this, connect the PC / PG to the system interface with the PC cable
(see the figure below).
Notice
With SIMOCODE pro C use the system interface on the front and with SIMOCODE pro S use the right-hand
system interface.
4 Start SIMOCODE ES.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 235
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
3& FDEOH
2UGHU 1R 8)$$
Note
This setting cannot be made if the TEST / RESET button has been blocked.
Proceed as follows:
Table 13-3 Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via the addressing plug
Step Description
1 Set the desired valid address on the DIP switch.
The switches are numbered.
For example, address 21: Put the "16"+"4"+"1" switches in the "ON" position.
2 Plug the addressing plug into the system interface. The "Device" LED lights up yellow.
3 Briefly press the TEST / RESET button. The address you set is now stored. The "Device" LED flashes yellow for
approx. 3 seconds.
4 Remove the addressing plug from the system interface.
SIMOCODE pro
236 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Table 13-4 Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Step Description
1 Switch on the power supply of the basic unit.
2 Connect the USB interface of the PC/PG and the system interface of the basic unit to the Sirius USB PC cable.
It may be necessary to install a device driver for the parameterization cable when using the USB PC cable for the
first time.
3 Observe the status LED on the basic unit. The "Device" LED should light up green.
SIMOCODE pro can be started up.
4a Setting the address of a device configured in SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) (as started in steps 2 and 3):
Under "Parameters → Fieldbus interface", set the "Station address" to the required address and then download
the parameterization to the device.
4b Setting the address of a SIMOCODE device without integration in the current project:
In the project navigator, open "Online access" via "Online & Diagnostics". Here, the device currently connected
to the serial interface can be accessed using "COM<x> [SIRIUS PtP] → Update accessible devices". If the serial
interface COM<x> should indicate a protocol other than SIRIUS PtP, you can change this via the context menu
(right mouse button) → Properties. There, under "Parameters → Fieldbus interface", set the "Station address"
to the required address and then download the change into the device again.
5 After the parameters have been transferred to the basic unit, the message confirming successful downloading
appears under "Info → General" in the status window.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 237
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
13.2.1.3 Diagnostics via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel (PROFIBUS)
The basic units and the operating panel have three LEDs for displaying specific device states:
Table 13-5 Diagnostics via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel
13.2.1.4 Diagnostics via LED display on the modules DM-F Local or DM-F PROFIsafe
See Manual Fail-safe Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (https://support.automation.siemens.com/
WW/view/en/50564852).
SIMOCODE pro
238 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
1 Switch on the power supply. In a fault-free state, the following LEDS should light up green:
• "Device" (lights up)
• "PORT 1 / PORT 2" when the PROFINET cable is connected (lighted or flashing).
Continue with step 2.
Otherwise, carry out diagnostics according to the LED display. For more information, see Chapter Diagnostics
via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel (PROFINET) (Page 243). Try to rectify the fault.
2 If you want to make SIMOCODE pro available to PROFINET, you must set the IP parameters and the PROFINET
device names. For more information, see Chapter Setting IP parameters and PROFINET device name
(Page 240).
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro or check the existing parameterization, e.g. with a PC on which SIMO‐
CODE ES (TIA Portal) software is installed. For this, connect the PC / PG to the system interface with the PC cable
(see the figure below).
4 Start SIMOCODE ES.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 239
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Setting IP parameters and PROFINET device name with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) via PC cable
Proceed as follows:
Table 13-7 Setting IP parameters and PROFINET device name with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) via PC cable
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal).
SIMOCODE pro
240 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
3 1st option: Create new project 2nd option: Do not create a new project
• In the Project view, create a new project via • In the portal view, click on the button "Online & Di‐
"Project → New" agnostics"
• Add a new device by double-clicking the button "Add new • Click "Accessible devices". The "Accessible devices"
device" in the project navigator and select the application window opens
in the device wizard. The selected application corre‐ • Click the "Start search" button
sponds to the description in the manual SIMOCODE pro -
• Select a station
Application examples (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743959).
• Check the device configuration and adapt it to the actual
configuration, if applicable
• Select the communication settings under "Parame‐
ters → PROFINET parameters" and set the IP parameters
and the device name
• Under "Parameters → Motor protection", set the current
setting and, if applicable, other parameters
• Adapt other parameters in the parameter editor if neces‐
sary
• Save the project and transfer the device parameters to the
device
4 Select the type of the PG/PC interface (SIRIUS PtP in this case)
5 Select the PG/PC interface via which the USB PC cable is con‐
nected to the computer.
6 Click on the "Start search" button and load the parameteriza‐
tion into the device.
After successfully transferring the parameters into the device
(see message in inspector window), the device is ready to
operate.
7 Select a suitable station. You can show the following devices/
stations:
• devices with the same addresses
• all compatible stations
• accessible stations
8 Click the "Connect..." button.
9 Open the "PROFINET parameters" dialog box in the parameter editor
10 Activate/deactivate "Overwrite IP parameters in device" and set the IP address, subnet mask, and router as appropriate.
The IP parameters are configured with SIMOCODE ES and transferred to the device. In this case, the "Overwrite IP
parameters in device" checkbox must be selected. Choose the IP parameters to match the configuration in the auto‐
mation system. If the IP parameters are assigned by the IO controller in the automation system, no setting is necessary
here and the "Overwrite IP parameters in device" checkbox must not be selected 1)
11 Enter the IP address.
12 Activate the checkbox "Use router" if you want to use a router
13 Enter the IP address (gateway) of the router
14 Select the device name to match the configuration in the automation system
15 Activate the "Overwrite device name in device" checkbox if you want to transfer the device name to the device.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 241
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
16 If necessary, select the "Web server activated" checkbox
17 If necessary, select the "OPC-UA server activated" checkbox
18 Select the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox if you want to synchronize the unbuffered real-time clock of SIMO‐
CODE pro V PN using the NTP procedure.
19 Enter the NTP server address when the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox is selected.
20 Enter a value for the time shift: -1440 min to +1440 min (default value: 0 min)
21 Enter a value for the cyclic update interval when the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox is selected: 10 to 86400 s
(default value: 10 s)
22 Load the data to the basic unit via "Online → Load to device" or click the corresponding button in the menu bar
1)
Note
Initial transfer of device name
The initial transfer of the device name must take place via the SIMOCODE pro system interface,
since the device cannot be reached via PROFINET as address settings are missing.
13.2.2.3 Setting the time manually after switch-on or recovery of the supply voltage
Step Description
1 Go online, e.g. via "Online & Diagnostics" → Accessible devices
2 • In the project navigator, double-click "Commissioning".
• Click on "Command"
• Choose "Set time (=PC time in UTC)
SIMOCODE pro
242 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
13.2.2.4 Diagnostics via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel (PROFINET)
The basic unit and the operating panel have LEDs for displaying specific device states:
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 243
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Table 13-9 Commissioning sequence of the SIMOCODE pro V Modbus basic unit
Step Description
1 Switch on the power supply. In a fault-free state, the "Device" LED should light up green.
2 Connect the PC / PG to the system interface with the PC cable (see the figure below)
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro or check the existing parameterization with a PC on which
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) is installed
4 If automatic baud rate detection is activated, the "Bus" LED flashes green as soon as the
setting selected by the controller is found.
When the controller exchanges data with the device, the "Bus" LED lights up green.
86%3& FDEOH
2UGHU 1R 8)$$
Figure 13-3 Connecting a PC to the SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU basic unit
SIMOCODE pro
244 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Note
The SIMOCODE ES Premium software does not have more functionality than
SIMOCODE ES Standard for SIMOCODE pro Modbus devices, but it can nevertheless be used for
commissioning.
The functional principle of SIMOCODE ES software is described in the online help. A "Getting
Started" is available on the internet in a multimedia format to help you become more familiar
with the software in the initial fundamental steps: Guided Tour (https://
www.industry.siemens.com/topics/global/en/tia-portal/tia-portal-framework/tabcardpages/
Pages/guided-tour.aspx)
Device addressing
As supplied, the default setting for the device address 126. This must be reassigned when
commissioning the devices.
Table 13-10 Setting the Modbus RTU address via addressing plug
Step Description
1 Set the desired valid address on the DIP switch.
The switches are numbered. Addresses from 1 to 247 can be assigned.
For example, address 21: Put the "16"+"4"+"1" switches in the "ON" position. 1)
2 Plug the addressing plug into the system interface. The "Device" LED lights up yellow.
3 Briefly press the "TEST/RESET" button. The address you set is now stored. The "Device" LED
flashes yellow for approx. 3 seconds.
4 Remove the addressing plug from the system interface.
1)
Note
Labeling for the address "128"
Labeling for the address "128" is not available on the addressing plug, that is, the unlabeled
switch corresponds to the address "128".
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 245
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Table 13-11 Setting the Modbus RTU address with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2 Start SIMOCODE ES
3 Select "Online → Go online" or click the "Go online" button
Communication parameters
The following Modbus communication parameters can be set in the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
software under "Parameters → Modbus":
SIMOCODE pro
246 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
• Baud rate: The baud rate of SIMOCODE pro V Modbus can be set in the range from 0.3 - 57.6
kbps. The parameter setting "auto" activates automatic baud rate detection with which the
device autonomously determines the setting selected by the controller. Automatic baud rate
search encompasses baud rates in the range from 4.8 ... 57.6 kbps.
Note
Automatic baud rate detection
Use of this function is only possible when the "Watchdog" function is activated.
Idle time:
Messages begin and end with a transmission break of at least 3.5 characters. The shortest
idle time depends on the baud rate. The following table shows the default values:
• Baud rate (detected): Information about the detected baud rate, if automatic baud rate
detection (baud rate = auto) is set.
• Modbus address: Setting the Modbus address for the SIMOCODE device. The address can be
set in the range from 1 - 247. As supplied, the address for SIMOCODE pro V devices is set to
the default value of 126
• Port configuration: The number of stop bits and the selected parity of the Modbus interface
can be set here. The following settings are possible:
– 8E1 - 1 stop bit, even parity
– 8O1 - 1 stop bit, odd parity
– 8N2 - 2 stop bits, no parity
– 8N1 - 1 stop bit, no parity
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 247
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
• Wait time / wait time (default value): The time duration of the pause between a received
request and the reply from SIMOCODE pro can be set with the "Wait time" and "Wait time
(default value)" parameters. If the default value of the Modbus specification is to be used,
selection of the "Wait time (default value)" parameter is recommended. The "Wait time"
parameter is available for free setting. The setting is made in ms. The smallest settable value
corresponds to the default value of the Modbus specification. If longer wait times are
required, these can be defined using the "Wait time" parameter.
• Watchdog / Watchdog time: Monitoring of the bus communication can be activated with
these parameters. This is necessary when automatic baud rate detection is selected, or if the
SIMOCODE device were to experience a fault if the bus communication fails. If the watchdog
is activated, SIMOCODE monitors whether a valid read or write access to the device occurs
within the set watchdog time. If this is not the case, SIMOCODE begins a new search for a
valid baud rate if automatic rate detection is set. In addition, a "Fault - bus" is generated if the
"Watchdog → Bus monitoring" parameter is also activated.
SIMOCODE pro
248 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
1 Switch on the power supply. In a fault-free state, the following LEDS should light up green:
• "Device" (lights up)
• "PORT 1 / PORT 2" when the Ethernet cable is connected (lighted or flashing).
Continue with step 2.
Otherwise, carry out diagnostics according to the LED display. For more information, see Chapter Diagnostics
via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel with EtherNet/IP (Page 252). Try to rectify the fault.
2 If you want to make SIMOCODE pro available to EtherNet/IP, you must set the IP parameters and the device
name. For more information, see Chapter Setting IP parameters and EIP device name (Page 249).
3 Parameterize SIMOCODE pro or check the existing parameterization, e.g. with a PC on which SIMOCODE ES
software is installed. For this, connect the PC / PG to the system interface with the PC cable (see the figure
below).
4 Start SIMOCODE ES.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 249
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
These parameters can be set in different ways, depending on the needs of the plant
configuration.
Setting IP parameters and EtherNet/IP device name with SIMOCODE ES via PC cable
Proceed as follows:
Table 13-13 Setting IP parameters and EtherNet/IP device name with SIMOCODE ES via PC cable
Step Description
1 Plug the PC cable into the system interface
2 Start SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
3 1st option: Create new project 2nd option: Do not create a new project
• In the Project view, create a new project via • In the portal view, click on the button "Online & Di‐
"Project → New" agnostics"
• Add a new device by double-clicking the button "Add new • Click "Accessible devices". The "Accessible devices"
device" in the project navigator and select the application window opens
in the device wizard. The selected application corre‐ • Click the "Start search" button
sponds to the description in the manual SIMOCODE pro -
• Select a station
Application examples (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109743959).
• Check the device configuration and adapt it to the actual
configuration, if applicable
• Select the communication settings under "Parameters →
Ethernet parameters" and set the IP parameters and the
device name
• Under "Parameters → Motor protection", set the current
setting and, if applicable, other parameters
• Adapt other parameters in the parameter editor if neces‐
sary
• Save the project and transfer the device parameters to
the device
4 Select the type of the PG/PC interface (SIRIUS PtP in this case)
5 Select the PG/PC interface via which the USB PC cable is con‐
nected to the computer.
6 Click on the "Start search" button and load the parameteriza‐
tion into the device.
After successfully transferring the parameters into the device
(see message in inspector window), the device is ready to
operate.
7 Select a suitable station. You can show the following devices/
stations:
• devices with the same addresses
• all compatible stations
• accessible stations
8 Click the "Connect..." button.
9 Open the "Ethernet parameters" dialog box in the parameter editor
SIMOCODE pro
250 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Step Description
10 Select "Use BOOTP/DHCP" if the IP parameters are obtained from a DHCP server and assigned to the IO Device.
If the DHCP mode is selected, SIMOCODE pro immediately receives an IP address if the DHCP server is available in the
same network. Otherwise the device searches for an IP address. If SIMOCODE pro finds no IP address when setting up
an online connection or during a loading operation, because no DHCP server is available in the network, SIMOCODE ES
assigns the device a temporary IP address. If the DHCP mode is selected, SIMOCODE pro accepts this temporary address
as if it came from a DHCP server. There are two options for deactivating a temporary IP address again:
• Restart the device by means of "Commissioning → Command → Restart/Cold start"
• Switch the device off and on again. After the restart, the device runs in the DHCP mode and looks for an IP address
again.
11 Activate/deactivate "Overwrite IP parameters in device" and set the IP address, subnet mask, and router as appropriate.
The IP parameters are configured with SIMOCODE ES and transferred to the device. In this case, the "Overwrite IP
parameters in device" checkbox must be selected. Choose the IP parameters to match the configuration in the auto‐
mation system. If the IP parameters are assigned by the IO controller in the automation system, no setting is necessary
here and the "Overwrite IP parameters in device" checkbox must not be selected 1)
12 Enter the IP address.
13 Activate the checkbox "Use router" if you want to use a router
14 Enter the IP address (gateway) of the router
15 Select the EtherNet/IP device name to match the configuration in the automation system.
16 Activate the "Overwrite device name in device" checkbox if you want to transfer the device name to the device.
17 If necessary, select the "Web server activated" checkbox
18 Select the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox if you want to synchronize the unbuffered real-time clock of SIMO‐
CODE pro V EIP using the NTP procedure.
19 Enter the NTP server address when the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox is selected.
20 Enter a value for the time shift: -1440 min to +1440 min (default value: 0 min)
21 Enter a value for the cyclic update interval when the "Activate NTP synchronization" checkbox is selected: 10 to 86400 s
(default value: 10 s)
22 Load the data to the basic unit via "Online → Load to device" or click the corresponding button in the menu bar
1)
Note
Initial transfer of device name
The initial transfer of the device name must occur via the SIMOCODE pro system interface, since
the device is not yet accessible via EtherNet/IP due to the missing address settings.
13.2.4.3 Set the time manually after switch-on or recovery of the supply voltage
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 251
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.2 Commissioning
Set the time manually after switch-on or recovery of the supply voltage
Step Description
1 Start SIMOCODE ES
2 Establish an online connection.
3 Set the device-internal real time clock via "Commissioning → Command → Set time (= PC time in UTC)"
13.2.4.4 Diagnostics via LED display on the basic unit and on the operator panel with EtherNet/
IP
The basic unit and the operating panel have LEDs for displaying specific device states:
SIMOCODE pro
252 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
13.3 Service
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 253
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
SIMOCODE pro
254 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Saving parameters from the basic unit into the memory module
Note
This function will not be available if the TEST / RESET button has been disabled.
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1. Plug the memory module into the system interface. The "Device" LED lights up yellow for
approx. 10 seconds. During this time, press the "TEST / RESET" button for approx. 3 seconds. The
parameters will be saved in the memory module. After successful data transfer, the "Device"
LED flickers yellow for approx. 3 seconds.
2. If necessary, unplug the memory module from the system interface.
Saving parameters from the memory module into the basic unit
Note
This function will not be available if the TEST / RESET button has been disabled.
Proceed as follows:
Table 13-16 Saving parameters from the memory module into the basic unit
Step Description
1. Plug the memory module into the system interface. The "Device" LED lights up yellow for approx.
10 seconds. During this time, briefly press the "TEST / RESET" button. The parameters will be
transferred to the basic unit. After successful data transfer, the "Device" LED flashes yellow for
approx. 3 seconds.
2. If necessary, unplug the memory module from the system interface.
Note
If the memory module is plugged in, the parameters will be transferred from the memory
module to the basic unit when the supply voltage is switched on.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 255
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Step Description
1. Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2. Start SIMOCODE ES.
3. Create a new project via "Create new project".
4. Switch to the project view.
5. Go online, e.g. via "Online & Diagnostics" in the project navigator
6. Open the "Online access" menu in the project navigator and select the suitable interface by
double-clicking it.
7. Double-click on "Update accessible devices".
8. Select "Online → Upload device as new station (hardware and software) ...".
9. Save the project.
Note
This function will not be available if the TEST / RESET button has been disabled.
Table 13-18 Saving parameters from a SIMOCODE ES file into the basic unit
Step Description
1. Plug the PC cable into the system interface.
2. Start SIMOCODE ES.
3. Open a project.
4. Select Online → Extended online connection.
5. Select the type of the PG/PC interface (SIRIUS PtP or PN/IE).
6. Select the PG/PC interface.
7. Click the "Start search" button. A search is made for compatible stations.
8. Select a station.
9. Load the parameters to the device via "Online → Load to device".
SIMOCODE pro
256 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Safety guidelines
WARNING
Replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules
The main power for the feeder and the supply voltage for the basic unit must be switched off
before replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules.
Note
Please observe the information contained in the Operating Instructions!
You will also find the Operating Instructions for SIMOCODE pro at Operating Instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man)
Note
It is not necessary to detach the wiring from the removable terminals to replace the components!
Step Description
1. Save the parameters. For information on this, see Chapter Backing up and saving parameters (Page 255).
2. Switch off the main power for the unit feeder and the power supply for the basic unit.
3. Withdraw the PC cable if necessary, then remove the cover or the connecting cable from the system interface.
4. Withdraw the removable terminals. You do not need to detach the wiring.
5. Dismantle the basic unit.
6. Withdraw the removable terminals from the new basic unit.
7. Mount the new basic unit.
8. Connect the wired, removable terminals.
9. Connect the cables to the system interfaces.
10. Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit.
11. Save the parameters into the basic unit. For information on this, see Chapter Backing up and saving parameters
(Page 255).
12. Switch on the main power for the unit feeder.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 257
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Step Description
1. Switch off the main power for the feeder and switch off the power supply for the basic unit and the DM-F.
2. Withdraw the PC cable if necessary, then remove the cover or the connecting cable from the system interface.
3. Withdraw the removable terminals. You do not need to detach the wiring.
4. Remove the expansion module or decoupling module.
5. Withdraw the removable terminals from the new expansion module or decoupling module.
6. Install the new expansion module or decoupling module.
7. Connect the wired, removable terminals.
8. Connect the cables to the system interfaces.
9. Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit.
10. Switch on the main power for the unit feeder.
Replacing a DM-F
Proceed as follows:
Step Description
1 First, switch off the main power for the feeder and then the supply voltage for the basic unit and the DM-F.
2 Withdraw the PC cable if necessary, then remove the cover or the connecting cable from the system interface.
3 Withdraw the removable terminals. You do not need to detach the wiring.
4 Dismantle the DM-F.
5 Withdraw the removable terminals from the new DM-F.
6 Mount the new DM-F.
7 Connect the wired, removable terminals.
8 Connect the cables to the system interfaces.
9 DM-F PROFIsafe only:
Set the DIP switches for the PROFIsafe address according to the configuration in the F-controller (see Chapter "Con‐
figuring the DM-F PROFIsafe and integrating it into the fail-safe automation system" in the manual Manual Fail-safe
Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (https://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852)).
10 Switch on the power supply for the DM-F and the basic unit.
11 DM-F Local only
Configure the DM-F Local accordingly (see Chapter "Configuring the DM-F Local" in manual Manual Fail-safe Digital
Modules SIMOCODE pro (https://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852)).
12 Switch on the main power for the unit feeder.
SIMOCODE pro
258 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Replacing the current measuring module and the current/voltage measuring module
WARNING
Replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules
The main power for the feeder and the supply voltage for the basic unit must be switched off
before replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules.
Proceed as follows:
Table 13-22 Replacing the current measuring module and the current/voltage measuring module
Step Description
1 Switch off the main power for the unit feeder and the power supply for the basic unit.
2 Pull out the connecting cable from the system interface.
3 Remove the removable terminal from the module as illustrated below (current / voltage measuring modules only)
4 Disconnect the three cables of the three phases of the main circuit.
5 Replace the module (see Chapter Mounting of current measuring modules (Page 167) and Chapter Mounting the
current / voltage measuring modules (Page 168)).
6 Connect the three cables of the main circuit, leading them through the feed-hole openings.
7 Plug the removable terminals onto the module (current / voltage measuring modules only).
8 Connect the cable to the system interface.
9 Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit.
10 Switch on the main power for the unit feeder.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 259
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
8 9
DEFG
Replacing a 1st generation current/voltage measuring module (UM) with a 2nd generation current/
voltage measuring module (UM+)
WARNING
Replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules
The main power for the feeder and the supply voltage for the basic unit must be switched off
before replacing current measuring modules and current/voltage measuring modules.
The following table shows which 2nd generation current/voltage measuring module replaces a
1st generation current/voltage measuring module:
1st generation current/voltage measuring module 2nd generation current/voltage measuring module
SIMOCODE pro
260 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Note
Conversion to a 2nd generation current/voltage measuring module
Depending on the previous parameterization of the SIMOCODE basic unit, the Device LED and
the General Fault LED may flash red when downloading a parameterization with a 2nd
generation current / voltage measuring module.
This behavior can be corrected with a reset. The device LED changes to green; the Gen. Fault LED
goes out.
After a reset, the basic unit is in the UM+ mode. The device LED changes to green; the Gen. Fault
LED goes out.
Table 13-23 Exchanging a 3UF52 operator panel for a 3UF720 operator panel
Step Description
1 Unscrew the four mounting bracket screws and remove the 3UF52 operator panel from the front panel or
switchgear cabinet door.
2 Ensure that the dimensions of the cutout in the front panel or cabinet door measure 91.5 + 0.5 mm (width) and
54.5 + 0.5 mm (height) (see figure).
3 Slide the seal provided onto the operator panel adapter (see figure).
4 Position the operator panel adapter in the cutout.
5 Position the operator panel in the adapter.
6 Snap the four mounting brackets onto the operator panel.
7 Lock the operator panel in position by tightening the four mounting bracket screws (see figure and safety infor‐
mation!).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 261
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
[
,3
WARNING
Tightening torque of the screws
To ensure that the panel will function correctly and is sealed to comply with IP54, the tightening
torque of the screws provided must not be set too high when mounting and the seal must be
properly fitted.
SIMOCODE pro
262 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Note
A SIMOCODE pro 3UF7 system operator panel is not compatible with SIMOCODE DP 3UF5, and
vice versa.
Restoring the factory settings with the TEST / RESET button on the basic unit
Proceed as follows (also deletes any previous password setting!):
Table 13-24 Restoring the factory settings with the TEST / RESET button
Step Description
1 Switch off the supply voltage for the basic unit.
2 Press the TEST / RESET button on the basic unit and keep it pressed.
3 Switch on the supply voltage for the basic unit. The "Device" LED lights up yellow.
4 Release the TEST / RESET button after approx. two seconds.
5 Press the TEST / RESET button again after approx. two seconds.
6 Release the TEST / RESET button after approx. two seconds.
7 Press the TEST / RESET button again after approx. two seconds.
8 The factory setting is restored.
Note
If any of the steps stated above are not carried out correctly, the basic unit will revert to normal
operation.
Note
This function is always active, irrespective of the "TEST / RESET keys disabled" parameter.
Restoring the factory settings with the software SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Prerequisite: SIMOCODE pro is connected to the PC / PG via PROFIBUS DP or via the system
interface and SIMOCODE ES is started.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 263
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Table 13-25 Restoring the factory settings with the software SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Step Description
1 Go online, e.g. via "Online → Connect online".
2 In the Project navigation view, select "Online accesses → COM [Sirius PtP] → Update accessible
stations → SIMOCODE → Commissioning → Command".
3 Click on the "Factory settings" button. The factory setting is restored.
4 "Factory settings OK" is displayed in the inspector window.
Note
The parameterization of the device is retained after the firmware has been updated.
NOTICE
Connection to the device
The connection by USB PC cable or Ethernet must not be interrupted during the update
procedure.
SIMOCODE pro
264 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.3 Service
Requirements:
• The basic unit must be connected to SIMOCODE ES via online connection, USB PC cable (PtP)
or Ethernet.
• The supply voltage must be present at the basic unit at the start of and during the firmware
update.
• A firmware update is only possible if
– The motor is in the "off" state and there is no motor current
– The control station is in "Local manual" status
– The device is not protected by a password
Firmware update
You can perform the firmware update as follows:
• for the SIMOCODE pro V PB and pro V MR basic units, via the SIRIUS PC USB cable (SIRIUS PtP)
with the assistance of the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) software, all versions
Basic / Standard / Premium V15 or higher or Professional V16 or higher.
• for the SIMOCODE pro V PN and pro V EIP basic units: via Ethernet with the assistance of the
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) software, all versions Basic / Standard / Premium V13 or higher or
Professional V16 or higher.
WARNING
Risk of impermissible system states.
The installation of the firmware update switches the basic unit into "station failure" state. This
state can affect the operation of an online process or a machine.
Unexpected operation of a process or a machine can lead to fatal or severe injuries and/or to
property damage.
Before installing the firmware update, ensure that the basic unit is not involved in an active
process.
Update procedure:
1. Select the module in the device configuration
2. Select the "Online & diagnostics" command from the shortcut menu
3. Select the "Firmware update" group from the "Functions" folder.
4. Click the "Browse" button to select the path to the firmware update files.
5. Select the firmware file from the folder into which you previously unpacked the download
file. The table in the "Firmware update" area lists those modules under "Suitable for modules
with" for which an update is possible with the selected firmware file.
6. Click the "Run update" button. If the module can interpret the selected file, the file is
downloaded to the module
Updating the firmware
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 265
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
The "Run firmware after update" check box is always selected. When the loading process is
complete, the module works with the new firmware.
Note
Avoid interrupting the firmware update
If you interrupt a firmware update, the device is not ready for use. In this case, the "BUS" and
"GEN FAULT" LED indicators flash alternately and the "DEVICE" LED lights up red.
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
266 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
Figure 13-10 Example of event logging using the SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
Example:
The most recent "power-on" event was logged at a device operating time of 17 days, 21 hours
and 31 minutes. Therefore, at the moment of "Power - On", the device was operating (supplied
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 267
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
with voltage) for 17d 21h 31min. The "Number of starts >" fault was logged at a device operating
time of 18 days, 22 hours, 17 minutes, i.e. 24h 46min after the most recent "Power - On."
When using a DM-F, the events "Enabling circuit closed" and "Enabling circuit open" are logged
for the DM-F Local and/or the DM-F PROFIsafe in a separate window:
• Time
• Event: "Enabling circuit closed" or "Enabling circuit open"
– Number:
Line 1 200 or 202
Line 2 201 or 203
– Text:
Line 1 "DM-F Local enabling circuit 0 -> 1" or "DM-F PROFIsafe enabling circuit 0 -> 1"
Line 2 "DM-F Local enabling circuit 1 -> 0" or "DM-F PROFIsafe enabling circuit 1 -> 0."
The current DIP switch position of the "DM-F Local" and/or the "DM-F PROFIsafe" is displayed
under "DIP switch position DM-F during the last event".
See also Chapter "Data record 72 - Error buffer" in the manual SIMOCODE pro - Communication
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
Note
This event memory is supported by the SIMOCODE pro V basic unit as from firmware
version V3.0.
The following events are stored:
• last event "DM-F enabling circuit closed"
• last event "DM-F enabling circuit open"
• Initialization module read in
• Initialization module written.
See also Chapter "Data record 73 - Event buffer" in the manual SIMOCODE pro - Communication
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
SIMOCODE pro
268 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 269
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
270 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 271
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
272 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 273
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
274 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 275
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
276 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 277
Commissioning, service, troubleshooting
13.4 Troubleshooting
1) See also "Error number" in Chapter "Data record 72 - Error buffer" in the manual SIMOCODE pro
- Communication (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743960).
Note
2) Parameter block
On devices in the as-delivered condition or after the factory settings have been restored, the
parameter block is not active!
SIMOCODE pro
278 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas 14
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor
protection)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 279
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
Note
This safety and commissioning information is also valid for devices with certificate numbers BVS
04 ATEX F 003.
The devices are suitable for protecting motors in potentially explosive areas in accordance with
the above standards.
WARNING
Use in hazardous locations
The components of SIMOCODE pro are not suitable for installation in hazardous areas.
The device is only allowed to be installed in a control cabinet with the minimum degree of
protection of IP 4x.
If you have any questions, ask your explosion protection specialist.
WARNING
Qualified personnel required
All work involved in connecting, commissioning and maintenance must be carried out
by qualified, responsible personnel.
Failure to follow proper procedures may result in personal injury and damage to property.
SIMOCODE pro
280 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
NOTICE
SIMOCODE pro Operating Instructions
Please observe the SIMOCODE pro Operating Instructions (enclosed with the devices).
You can find the Operating Instructions for SIMOCODE pro listed in Chapter General
information about commissioning and service (Page 233) or at Operating Instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man) in the Industry Online Support.
Notes/example
Set the 3UF7 to the rated motor current (according to the type plate or design test certificate of
the motor).
NOTICE
Trip class / tripping characteristic
Pay attention to the trip class or the tripping characteristic of the 3UF7.
Choose the trip class so that the motor is thermally protected even with a blocked rotor.
The motor, cables, and contactor must be dimensioned for the selected trip class.
NOTICE
Setting the "response" of the overload protection
Set the response of the overload protection to "Trip"!
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 281
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
E
E
E
E
TE = 11 s E
IA/Is = 5.5
Figure 14-1 Tripping conditions of the Ex e motor, selected: CLASS 10E when using a 3UF710* current
measuring module
The latest tripping characteristics for SIMOCODE pro can be found in the Industry Online Support
(Tripping characteristics 3UF7 (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/search?
search=3UF7&type=Characteristic&lc=en-WW)).
NOTICE
Tripping characteristic
The type of tripping characteristic is dependent on the configured measuring module.
If a 3UF711*-1AA00-0 1st generation current / voltage measuring module is configured in a
parameter assignment, although a 3UF711*-1AA01-0 2nd generation current / voltage
measuring module is used, then the tripping characteristic remains that of the 1st generation
current / voltage measuring module.
If only the hardware of the measuring module is replaced, this does not result in any change to
the tripping behavior.
SIMOCODE pro
282 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
Depending on the number of sensors, the following tripping and restart temperatures will result
based on the TNF (rated response temperature of the sensor):
CAUTION
Response setting
Set the response for the activated thermistor to "Trip"!
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 283
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
NOTICE
Installing the measuring circuit cables
Lay the measuring circuit cables as separate control cables. It is not permissible to use the cores
of the motor supply cable or other main supply cables.
Shielded control cables should be used if extremely inductive or capacitive interference is
expected as a result of power cables routed in parallel.
NOTICE
Evaluation of the short-circuit detection of the sensor cable
Evaluating the short-circuit detection of the sensor cable is recommended.
If the short-circuit detection of the sensor cable is not evaluated, when commissioning or after
modifications / maintenance work (assembly, disassembly) of the system, the sensor resistor
must be measured using a suitable measuring instrument.
NOTICE
Fuse protection of the contactor for type of coordination 2
When combining with other contactors, observe the respective maximum fuse protection of
the contactor for type of coordination 2.
SIMOCODE pro
284 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
NOTICE
Cable cross sections
Avoid impermissibly high cable surface temperatures by correctly dimensioning the cross
sections!
Choose a sufficient cable cross section, especially for heavy-starting motors CLASS 20E to
CLASS 40E (see Chapter Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders for short-circuit
currents up to 100 kA and 690 V for 1st generation current / voltage measuring module
(Page 331))
14.1.3.7 Test
Test phases
• Phase 1: Hardware test / lamp test (0 to 2 s):
The hardware (e.g. the thermistor electronics) is tested, all LEDs and displays are activated,
including the lamp control. Contactor controls remain unchanged.
• Phase 2: Hardware test results (2 s to 5 s):
If there is a fault, the "HW fault basic unit" fault is triggered.
If there is no fault:
– the "GEN. FAULT" LED flashes if no main current is flowing
– the "GEN. FAULT" LED flickers; if main current is flowing in all three phases (exception:
with a "1-phase load" in one phase).
• Phase 3: Relay test (> 5 s):
If testing is carried out with tripping, the contactor controls are deactivated.
The contactor control can only be shut down by means of the "Test 1" function block and in the
"Local 1-3" operating mode, using the "TEST / RESET" button on the basic device / operator panel.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 285
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
The following table shows the test phases performed when the "TEST / RESET" button is pressed
for the required length of time:
Table 14-3 States of the status LEDs / contactor controls during testing
WARNING
Safety information for DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital modules
Pay attention to the safety notes in the Manual Fail-safe Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (http://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852).
CAUTION
Using relay outputs for the protection function
For the protection function, only the relay outputs of the 3UF70 basic unit, of a monostable
digital module 3UF730, of a multifunction module 3UF76, or of a fail-safe expansion
module 3UF732/3UF733 may be used, and only if connected to the corresponding contactor
controls "QE" of the control function!
SIMOCODE pro
286 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
WARNING
The 3UF7 is not suitable for installation in hazardous areas.
The device is only allowed to be installed in a control cabinet with the minimum degree of
protection of IP 4x.
If installed in hazardous areas, there must be no ignition hazard from the 3UF7. Appropriate
measures must be taken (e.g. encapsulation).
WARNING
Electrical isolation required
For SIMOCODE pro devices with a 24 V DC control supply, galvanic isolation must be ensured
with a battery or a safety isolating transformer according to DIN EN 61558-2-6.
Note
The 3UF7 is not suitable for load-side operation on frequency converters.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 287
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.1 Motor protection functions (overload protection, thermistor protection)
WARNING
Repairs
Repairs to the device may only be carried out by the manufacturer.
14.1.5 Warranty
Note
To meet the conditions of the warranty, you must observe the safety and commissioning
instructions from the operating instructions.
You can find the Operating Instructions for SIMOCODE pro listed in Chapter General information
about commissioning and service (Page 233) or at Operating Instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man) in the Industry Online Support.
SIMOCODE pro
288 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
WARNING
Use in hazardous locations
The components of SIMOCODE pro are not suitable for installation in hazardous areas.
The device is only allowed to be installed in a control cabinet with the minimum degree of
protection of IP 4x.
If you have any questions, ask your explosion protection specialist.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 289
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
NOTICE
Overall ignition protection concept
According to the overall ignition protection concept for the centrifugal pump, further
independent monitoring devices may be necessary, depending on the requirement level, to
avoid ignition sources in the event of expected and/or rare malfunctions. Failure of this "dry-
running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring" device for control of
ignition sources is regarded as a rare malfunction.
WARNING
Qualified personnel required
All work involved in connecting, commissioning and maintenance must be carried out
by qualified, responsible personnel.
Failure to follow proper procedures may result in personal injury and damage to property.
With SIMOCODE pro the dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps (non-electrical device)
works by active power monitoring and shutdown of the motor if a minimum flow rate is
undershot. This corresponds to the following type of ignition protection: Control of ignition
sources b, ignition protection system b1, e.g. according to DIN EN 80079‑37
SIMOCODE pro is registered for dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power
monitoring according to both ATEX and IEC Ex.
Increased danger in hazardous areas means it is necessary to carefully observe the following
notes and standards:
• IEC 60079‑14 / EN 60079‑14 / DIN VDE 0165‑1 Electrical apparatus for explosive gas
atmospheres ‑ Electrical installations in hazardous areas (other than mines)
• IEC 60079‑17 / EN 60079‑17 / DIN VDE 0165‑10‑1 Electrical apparatus for explosive gas
atmospheres ‑ Explosive atmospheres. Electrical installations inspection and maintenance
(other than mines)
• DIN EN 50495 Safety devices required for the safe functioning of equipment with respect to
explosion risks
• VDE 0118 Erection of electrical installations in mines
• DIN EN ISO 80079‑36 Explosive atmospheres - Part 36: Non-electric equipment for use in
explosive atmospheres - Basic method and requirements
• DIN EN ISO 80079‑37 Explosive atmospheres - Part 37: Non-electrical equipment for
explosive atmospheres - Non-electrical type of protection constructional safety ''c'', control of
ignition sources ''b'', liquid immersion ''k''
• DIN EN 1127‑1 Explosive atmospheres - Explosion prevention and protection - Part 1: Basic
concepts and methodology
SIMOCODE pro
290 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
• DIN EN 13237 Potentially explosive atmospheres – Terms and definitions for equipment and
protective systems intended for use in potentially explosive atmospheres
• DIN EN 15198 Methodology for the risk assessment of non-electrical equipment and
components for intended use in potentially explosive atmospheres
• National implementation of Directive 1999/92/EC
Marking on the nameplate of the SIMOCODE pro device with meaning with regard to the
possible applications of the centrifugal pumps to be protected in hazardous areas:
• PTB 18 ATEX 5003 X / ITS21UKEX0455X
• IECEx PTB 18.0004 X
• I (1G/M2) [Ex h Ga/Mb]
• II (1/2) G [Ex h Ga/Gb]
• II (1G/2D) [Ex h Ga/Db]
Explanation of marking:
Notes regarding the term "device":
• The electrical device to be marked (SIMOCODE pro) is installed in the non-hazardous area.
• The marking refers to the requirements for the non-electrical device (centrifugal pump) to be
protected, which is installed in the hazardous area or in which a hazardous area may be
present.
• The protection function of the SIMOCODE pro device is achieved by monitoring/avoiding
ignition sources on the device to be protected (centrifugal pump) by preventing dry running.
All valid device combinations (see Module integration (Page 289)) are permitted:
• For explosion protection outside of the equipment (centrifugal pump)
– Under Equipment Group I, Equipment category M2 (mining) for mines endangered by
firedamp
– Under Equipment Group II, Equipment category 2G (potentially explosive gas
atmospheres, zone 1)
– Under Equipment Group II, Equipment category 2D (potentially explosive dust
atmospheres, zone 21)
• For explosion protection within the equipment (centrifugal pump). In this case, approval
relates to both stated Equipment Groups and Equipment category 1G (potentially explosive
gas atmospheres, zone 0).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 291
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
NOTICE
Monitoring equipment required
Take steps to ensure that the system cannot operate without any additional monitoring
equipment required by the overall ignition protection concept.
NOTICE
Points to observe
To ensure that SIMOCODE pro is used as intended for dry-running protection for centrifugal
pumps by active power monitoring in hazardous areas, observe the stipulations from this
manual as well as the stipulations from the manuals provided by the manufacturers of the
centrifugal pump and the motor.
The devices are suitable for dry-running protection of centrifugal pumps by active power
monitoring in hazardous areas in accordance with the above standards.
Tests other than those legally stipulated (Ordinance on Industrial Safety and Health) are
not required.
NOTICE
SIMOCODE pro Operating Instructions
Please observe the SIMOCODE pro Operating Instructions (enclosed with the devices).
You can find the Operating Instructions for SIMOCODE pro listed in Chapter General
information about commissioning and service (Page 233) or at Operating Instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man) in the Industry Online Support.
SIMOCODE pro
292 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
NOTICE
Operating instructions from the manufacturer of the centrifugal pump and the
manufacturer of the motor used to drive the pump
Observe the operating instructions from the manufacturer of the centrifugal pump that is to be
protected against dry running as well as those from the manufacturer of the motor used to
drive the pump
WARNING
Qualified personnel required
All work involved in connecting, commissioning and maintenance must be carried out
by qualified, responsible personnel.
Failure to follow proper procedures results in personal injury and damage to property.
NOTICE
Information provided by the pump manufacturer
Observe all information provided by the pump manufacturer concerning installation /
mounting / preconditions for commissioning.
NOTICE
Setting the motor's rated current
Set the motor's rated current IE (see nameplate) correctly in SIMOCODE pro.
The automatic zero point measurement at I < 0.1*IE can lead to unintended shutdowns if IE is
set too high.
NOTICE
Commissioning and operation of the centrifugal pumps to be protected
You must commission and operate the centrifugal pumps that are to be protected in
accordance with the pump manufacturer's stipulations.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 293
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
NOTICE
Suitability of the device for control of ignition sources
The device for control of ignition sources is suitable for centrifugal pumps with progressive
flow characteristics with sufficient distance between the active powers PMIN at the minimum
flow rate QMIN and POPT at the operating point QOPT with PMIN / POPT < 0.80.
CAUTION
Setting the required switching levels
Set the dry-running protection by active power monitoring to the required switching level and
check that it is working correctly.
The equipment may not be used as a device for control of ignition sources for monitoring the
liquid filling of a centrifugal pump installed in a potentially explosive atmosphere until the
combination pump/motor/shutdown has been successfully tested.
NOTICE
Checking the set parameter values
Check the parameter values that have been set with respect to their suitability for the
protection function in terms of avoiding dry running when required (following any changes in
the pump or system characteristics, e.g. as a result of changing the operating medium or of
intervention in the plant configuration). Correct the parameter values where necessary.
To determine the active power from which the trip level is derived, you must either use the
same 3UF7 system, with which the shutdown function is realized, or an identical system with
the same functionality. External measuring equipment is not permitted for determining the
active power.
NOTICE
Monitoring limit values
Make sure that the pump is shut down when the limit values for monitoring are reached.
CAUTION
No automatic restart
Take steps to ensure that the drive motor cannot automatically restart.
Acknowledge any fault manually once it has been remedied.
NOTICE
Periodic function tests
Test the device for control of ignition sources in accordance with the operating instructions on
a periodic basis to make sure it is working correctly (see sections Test (Page 297) and Periodic
tests (Page 300)).
SIMOCODE pro
294 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
Example
Set the following parameters in SIMOCODE pro:
• Trip level: PTRIP threshold value for active power monitoring to prevent dry running:
PTRIP < (lower limit): 0 - 750000 W (default setting: 0)
• Delay time for preventing incorrect tripping caused by short undershooting of the PTRIP
threshold value during operation: tV,TRIP: 0 - 10 s (default setting: 0.5 s, incrementally: 0.1 s)
• Start-up bridging time for preventing incorrect tripping caused by short undershooting of
the PTRIP threshold value during start-up of the centrifugal pump (depending on the
procedure used to open the pressure-side shut-off valve): tBRIDGE : 0 - 60 s (default setting: 0 s,
incrementally: 0.5 s). During the start-up bridging time, the dry-running protection function
is suppressed. If the trip level is still undershot after expiry of tBRIDGE , then the delay time tV,TRIP
starts to run from this instant.
Parameters can be entered directly in SIMOCODE ES.
To determine the trip level, you must perform an active power measurement with a
corresponding 3UF7 system beforehand (either with the same system, which is also used for
monitoring, or with an identical system with the same functionality). You will find the
parameters in the project for the respective SIMOCODE pro device in the parameter editor under
"Dry-running protection". You must upload the parameters manually to the device.
However, we recommend a "teach-in" to determine and enter the parameters. This must be
carried out with the medium being pumped. You can initially carry out the teach-in with water
during the cold commissioning of the production plant. However, it is essential that you repeat
the procedure with operating medium under operational conditions.
SIMOCODE ES engineering software will support you when carrying out the teach-in by
providing a dry-running wizard.
To start the wizard, go to the online view and open the commissioning editor for the respective
SIMOCODE device in the project. You will find the wizard there under "Dry running wizard".
Note
Teach-in procedure
The teach-in procedure as well as that for direct entry of the parameters is described in the
chapter "Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps" in the manual Parameterizing
SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958).
Note
Log file
For verification purposes, we recommend generating a log file (see Chapter "Dry-running
protection of centrifugal pumps" in the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/109743958)) after setting the parameters
(whether done as a teach-in or by means of direct entry using SIMOCODE ES).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 295
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
Note
Activating the dry-running protection function
This function is deactivated in the as-delivered state.
The function is activated following a successful run-through with the wizard. The response of
the dry-running protection at PTRIP < (lower threshold) is set to "Trip".
Note
Default setting for response
The response of the dry-running protection at PTRIP < (lower threshold) is preset to "Trip".
Note
Setting the warning level
You have the option of configuring an additional warning level for undershooting of active
power using the "Active power monitoring" function (see Chapter "Active power monitoring" in
the manual Parameterizing SIMOCODE pro (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/
view/109743958)). This becomes effective before the trip level PTRIP is undershot.
However, this warning level is of no relevance with respect to approval for use in hazardous
areas.
NOTICE
Manufacturer's instructions on the centrifugal pump
Observe the manufacturer's instructions for the centrifugal pump, which must be protected
against dry running, in particular the characteristic curve which supplies the information on
the minimum flow rate and possible information for the procedure during startup and
shutdown of the pump / motor.
NOTICE
Cable / conductor cross sections
Avoid impermissible maximum cable surface temperatures by correctly dimensioning the cross
sections!
Choose a sufficient cable cross section, especially for heavy-starting motors CLASS 20E to
CLASS 40E (see Chapter Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders for short-circuit
currents up to 100 kA and 690 V for 1st generation current / voltage measuring module
(Page 331))
SIMOCODE pro
296 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
14.2.3.6 Test
Note
Must be carried out periodically
You must repeat the general system tests at least every 3 years (cf. IEC 60079-17, Section 4.4.2).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 297
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
Note
Automation
If you wish to reduce the amount of manual intervention, you can store appropriate sequences
in your process control system for (partially) automated running of the system test with
operating medium.
SIMOCODE pro
298 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
WARNING
Safety information for DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe fail-safe digital modules
Pay attention to the safety notes in the Manual Fail-safe Digital Modules SIMOCODE pro (http://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852).
CAUTION
Using relay outputs for the protection function
For the protection function, only the relay outputs of the 3UF70 basic unit, of a monostable
digital module 3UF730, of a multifunction module 3UF76, or of a fail-safe expansion
module 3UF732/3UF733 may be used, and only if connected to the corresponding contactor
controls "QE" of the control function!
WARNING
Electrical isolation required
For SIMOCODE pro devices with a 24 V DC control supply, you must ensure galvanic isolation
with a battery or a safety isolating transformer according to DIN EN 61558‑2‑6.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 299
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
Note
SIMOCODE pro is not suitable for load-side operation on frequency converters.
Note
Calibration of active power measurement
Active power measurement is calibrated just once prior to shipment of the equipment.
It is not necessary to repeat calibration during the equipment's lifetime when used in hazardous
areas for dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by means of active power monitoring.
SIMOCODE pro
300 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
WARNING
Repairs
Repairs to the device may only be carried out by the manufacturer.
14.2.6 Warranty
Note
To meet the conditions of the warranty, you must observe the safety and commissioning
information from the operating instructions.
You can find the Operating Instructions for SIMOCODE pro listed in Chapter General information
on installation and commissioning (Page 293) or at Operating Instructions (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/ps/16027/man) in the Industry Online Support.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 301
Safety and commissioning information for Ex areas
14.2 Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring
SIMOCODE pro
302 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications 15
15.1 Common technical data
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 303
Technical specifications
15.1 Common technical data
SIMOCODE pro
304 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.3 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
To ensure touch protection and degree of protection IP20 for SIMOCODE pro S, screw in all screws that are not used for conductor
clamping and close the terminal covers.
See also
Wiring, connecting (Page 172)
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Mounting Snap-mounted onto 35-mm standard mounting rail or screw-mounted us‐
ing additional push-in lugs
Cabinet mounting basic unit SIMOCODE pro S Minimum distance to be maintained
(3UF7020) • from cabinet rear wall for series mounting at side: 0 mm
• from grounded parts at side: 2 mm
Display
Red / green / yellow "DEVICE" LED • Red: "Function test negative, device disabled"
• Green: "Ready for operation"
• Yellow: "Memory module or addressing plug detected"
• OFF: "No control supply voltage"
Green "BUS" LED • Continuous light: "Communication with PLC/PCS"
• Flashing: "Baud rate recognized/communication with PC/PG"
• Flickering: "Communication interrupted"
Red "GEN. FAULT" LED Continuous light/flashing: "Feeder fault," e.g. overload tripping
"TEST/RESET" button • Resets the device after tripping
• Function test (system self-test)
• Operation of memory module or addressing plug
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 305
Technical specifications
15.3 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
System interfaces
Front, right-hand side (pro S) For connecting an operator panel or expansion modules. The memory
module, addressing plug or a PC cable can also be connected to the system
interface for parameterization purposes.
Bottom, front (pro C, pro V) Connection of a current measuring module or a current/voltage measuring
module
Front, left-hand side (pro S) Connection of a current measuring module
PROFIBUS DP interface
Interface (physical) RS485
Connection technology 1)
9-way sub D socket (12 Mbit)
Pin assignment acc. to DIN EN 61158-2
Terminals (1.5 Mbit)
Connection of a PROFIBUS DP cable via terminal connection or a 9-pole sub
D socket.
Pin assignment:
1: n. c.: Reserved
2: n. c.: Reserved
3: BUS B: Data line B
4: RTS: Transmission request
5: P-: Ground
6: P+: Supply voltage
7: n. c.: Reserved
8: BUS A: Data line A
9: n. c.: Reserved
-: SHIELD: Shield over connector housing
Load rating 5 V DC on PROFIBUS DP: Max. 100 mA
Support for the transfer rates defined by the PROFIBUS DP standard:
9.6 Kbit / s, 19.2 Kbit / s, 45.45 Kbit / s, 93.75 Kbit / s, 187.5 Kbit / s,
500 Kbit / s, 1500 Kbit / s, 3000 Kbit / s, 6000 Kbit / s, 12000 Kbit / s.
Note
The 5 V power supply is only sufficient to power the bus termination mod‐
ule, not any other loads.
Supported data transfer rates for Modbus RTU:
300 baud, 600 baud, 1,200 baud, 2,400 baud, 4,800 baud, 9,600 baud,
19,200 baud (default), 57,600 baud
SIMOCODE pro
306 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.3 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Rated control supply voltage Us (according to 110 V to 240 V AC/DC, 50/60 Hz 24 V DC
DIN EN 61131-2)
Warning
For the 24 V DC power supply, always use an SELV
or PELV power supply unit!
Operating range 0.85 x Us to 1.1 x Us 0.8 x Us to 1.2 x Us
Power consumption
SIMOCODE pro C (3UF7000) / pro S (3UF7020). SIMOCODE pro C basic unit:
Measurement conditions: Room temperature, 5.3 VA / 2.9 W 2.3 W
combination of basic unit, current acquisition
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit:
module and operator panel, each with 2 LEDs
switched on and active inputs and outputs, active 4.7 VA / 2.5 W 2.1 W
thermistor, and 1.5 MBd bus transmission rate
SIMO‐ SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit:
CODE pro V PB (3UF7010) / pro V MR (3UF7012): 8.3 VA / 3.6 W 2.6 W
Measurement conditions: Room temperature,
SIMOCODE pro V MR basic unit:
combination of basic unit, current/voltage acquis‐
ition modules and operator panel with display, 8.3 VA / 3.6 W 2.6 W
each with 2 LEDs switched on and active inputs
and outputs, active thermistor, and 1.5 MBd bus
transmission rate
Rated insulation voltage Ui 300 V (at pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp 4 kV
Power failure backup time (longer power fail‐ SIMOCODE pro C
ures lead to shutdown of the relay outputs 24 V DC Typ. 50 ms
(monostable))
110 V to 240 V AC/DC
SIMOCODE pro S Typ. 50 ms
SIMOCODE pro V - 24 V DC Typ. 50 ms
SIMOCODE pro V - 110 V - Typ. 200 ms
240 V AC/DC
Relay outputs
Number Monostable relay outputs:
3 (SIMOCODE pro C, pro V)
2 (SIMOCODE pro S)
Function Isolated NO contacts (NO contact response parameterizable via internal
signal conditioning), 2 relay outputs connected to common potential, one
separate relay output, freely-assignable to control functions (e.g. line, star
or delta contactor or operating state status information.)
Stipulated short-circuit protection for auxiliary • 6 A fuse inserts, operational class gG; 10 A quick-response
contacts (relay outputs) (IEC 60947-5-1)
• Miniature circuit breaker 1.6 A, C characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1)
• Miniature circuit breaker 6 A, C characteristic (Ik < 500 A)
Rated uninterrupted current 5A
6 A at max. +50 °C
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 307
Technical specifications
15.3 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
Rated switching capacity • AC-15:
6 A / 24 V AC;
6 A / 120 V AC;
3 A / 230 V AC
• DC-13:
2 A / 24 V DC;
0.55 A / 60 V DC;
0.25 A / 125 V DC
Inputs (binary) 4 inputs connected to common potential that are supplied via the device
electronics (24 V DC) for measuring process signals (e.g. local control sta‐
tion, key-operated switch, limit switch, etc.), freely-assignable to control
functions.
24 V DC
Cable lengths (single) 300 m
Input characteristic Type 1 according to EN 61131-2
Thermistor motor protection (PTC binary)
Total cold resistance ≤ 1.5 kOhm
Response value 3.4 kOhm to 3.8 kOhm
Return value 1.5 kOhm to 1.65 kOhm
Sensor short-circuit response value < 9 ohm
Cable lengths (single), conductor cross sections: 250 m: 2.5 mm2
150 m: 1.5 mm2
50 m: 0.5 mm2
Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring (for 3UF7010-1A.00-0 basic unit)
Trip level – active power 0 - 750000 W (default setting: 0)
Delay time during pump operation 0 s ... 10 s
Start-up bridging time when starting pump 0 s ... 60 s
Connection of SIMOCODE pro C / pro V basic units
• Tightening torque TORQUE: 7 lb.in to 10.3 lb.in 0.8 Nm to 1.2 Nm
• Connection cross sections
- Solid 2 x0.5 mm2 ... 2.5 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 ... 4 mm2
2 x AWG 20 to 14 / 1 x AWG 20 to 12
- Finely stranded with end sleeve 2 x 0.5 mm2 ... 1.5 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 ... 2.5 mm2
2 x AWG 20 to 16 / 1 x AWG 20 to 14
- PROFIBUS cable 2 x 0.34 mm2 AWG 22
Connection of SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
• Tightening torque TORQUE: 5.2 lb.in to 7.0 lb.in
0.6 Nm to 0.8 Nm
• Connection cross sections
- Solid 2 x 0.5 mm2 ... 1.5 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 ... 2.5 mm2
2 x AWG 20 to 16 / 1 x AWG 20 to 14
SIMOCODE pro
308 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.4 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / pro V PB / pro V MR basic units
- Finely stranded with end sleeve 2 x 0.5 mm2 ... 1.0 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 ... 2.5 mm2
- PROFIBUS cable 2 x 0.34 mm2 / 1 x 0.34 mm2
AWG 22
1)
Note
Bus termination module
The bus termination module is powered by a voltage of max. 5 V.
The current drawn for the bus termination module is limited.
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Mounting Snap-mounted onto 35-mm standard mounting rail or screw-mounted us‐
ing additional push-in lugs
Mounting position Any
Display
Red/green/yellow "DEVICE" LED • Red: "Function test negative, device disabled"
• Green: "Ready for operation"
• Yellow: "Memory module detected"
• OFF: "No control supply voltage"
Green "BUS" LED • Continuous light: "Communication with PLC/PCS"
• Flashing: "Baud rate recognized/communication with PC/PG"
Red "GEN. FAULT" LED Continuous light/flashing: "Feeder fault", e.g. overload tripping
Green "PORT1" LED • Continuous light: Ethernet connection available
• Flashing: Station flash test
Green "PORT2" LED • Continuous light: Ethernet connection available
• Flashing: Station flash test
"TEST/RESET" button • Resets the device after tripping
• Function test (system self-test)
• Operation of memory module
System interfaces
Front For connecting an operator panel or expansion modules. The memory
module or a PC cable can also be connected to the system interface for
parameterization purposes.
Bottom Connection of a current measuring module or a current/voltage measuring
module
ETHERNET interface
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 309
Technical specifications
15.4 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Connection system 2 x RJ45 (LAN)
Transmission rate Max. 100 Mbit/s
Number of interfaces according to PROFINET 2
1 (SIMOCODE pro V PN GP 3UF7011-1A.00-2 basic units)
PROFINET conformity class B
Protocols supported PROFINET IO, PROFIsafe, LLDP, SNMP, Address Resolution Protocol (ARP),
HTTP, HTTPS, OPC UA Server, NTP
Autonegation Yes
Autosensing Yes
MRP/MRRP redundancy procedure Yes
No (SIMOCODE pro V PN GP 3UF7011-1A.00-2 basic units)
PROFINET IO system redundancy Yes
PROFIenergy measured values Yes
PROFIenergy shutdown Yes
Rated control supply voltage Us (according to 110 V to 240 V AC/DC, 50/60 Hz 24 V DC
DIN EN 61131-2)
Warning
For the 24 V DC power supply, always use an SELV
or PELV power supply unit!
Operating range 0.85 x Us to 1.1 x Us (startup) 0.85 x Us to 1.2 x Us (startup)
0.85 x Us to 1.1 x Us (operation) 0.80 x Us to 1.2 x Us (operation)
Power consumption
SIMOCODE pro V PN (3UF7011) and SIMO‐ SIMOCODE pro V PN basic unit:
CODE pro V EIP (3UF7013): 8.3 VA / 4.8 W 3.9 W
Measurement conditions: Room temperature,
SIMOCODE pro V EIP basic unit:
combination of basic unit, current/voltage acquis‐
ition module and operator panel with display, 8.3 VA / 4.8 W 3.9 W
each with 2 LEDs switched on and active inputs
and outputs, active thermistor, and 100 MBd bus
transmission rate
Rated insulation voltage Ui 300 V (at pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp 4 kV
Power failure backup time (longer power fail‐ • 24 V DC Typ. 20 ms
ures lead to shutdown of the relay outputs • 110 V to 240 V AC/DC
(monostable))
Relay outputs
Number 3 monostable relay outputs
Function Isolated NO contacts (NO contact response parameterizable via internal
signal conditioning), 2 relay outputs connected to common potential, one
separate relay output, freely-assignable to control functions (e.g. line, star
or delta contactor or operating state status information.)
Stipulated short-circuit protection for auxiliary • 6 A fuse inserts, operational class gG; 10 A quick-response
contacts (relay outputs) (IEC 60947-5-1)
• Miniature circuit breaker 1.6 A, C characteristic (IEC 60947-5-1)
• Miniature circuit breaker 6 A, C characteristic (Ik < 500 A)
SIMOCODE pro
310 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.4 Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units
Rated uninterrupted current • 5A
• 6 A at max. +50 °C
Rated switching capacity • AC-15:
6 A / 24 V AC;
6 A / 120 V AC;
3 A / 230 V AC
• DC-13:
2 A/24 V DC;
0.55 A / 60 V DC;
0.25 A / 125 V DC
Contact rating of the auxiliary contacts according B300/R300
to UL
Electrical durability (operating cycles) Typical: 100 000
Mechanical durability (operating cycles) Typical: 10 000 000
Inputs (binary) 4 inputs connected to common potential that are supplied via the device
electronics (24 V DC) for measuring process signals (e.g. local control sta‐
tion, key-operated switch, limit switch, etc.), freely-assignable to control
functions.
24 V DC
Cable lengths (single) 300 m
Input characteristic Type 1 according to EN 61131-2
Thermistor motor protection (PTC binary)
Total cold resistance ≤ 1.5 kOhm
Response value 3.4 kOhm to 3.8 kOhm
Return value 1.5 kOhm to 1.65 kOhm
Sensor short-circuit response value < 9 ohm
Cable lengths (single), conductor cross sections: 250 m: 2.5 mm2
150 m: 1.5 mm2
50 m: 0.5 mm2
Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by active power monitoring (for 3UF7011-1A.00-0 and 3UF7013-1A.00-0
basic units)
Trip level – active power 0 - 750000 W (default setting: 0)
Delay time during pump operation 0 s ... 10 s
Start-up bridging time when starting pump 0 s ... 60 s
Connection
Tightening torque TORQUE: 7 lb.in - 10.3 lb.in; 0.8 Nm - 1.2 Nm
Connection cross sections
• Solid 2 x 0.5 mm2 - 2.5 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 - 4 mm2;
2 x AWG 20 to 14 / 1 x AWG 20 to 12
• Finely stranded with end sleeve 2 x 0.5 mm2 - 1.5 mm2; 1 x 0.5 mm2 - 2.5 mm2;
2 x AWG 20 to 16 / 1 x AWG 20 to 14
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 311
Technical specifications
15.5 Technical data of the current measuring modules and the current / voltage measuring modules
15.5 Technical data of the current measuring modules and the current /
voltage measuring modules
SIMOCODE pro
312 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.5 Technical data of the current measuring modules and the current / voltage measuring modules
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 313
Technical specifications
15.5 Technical data of the current measuring modules and the current / voltage measuring modules
Technical data of the current measuring modules or the 1st generation current / voltage measuring modules
Mounting
Current set‐ Snap-mounted onto 35-mm standard mounting rail or screw-mounted using ad‐
ting Is = 0.3 A to 3 A; 2.4 A to 25 A; 10 A to ditional push-in lugs
100 A
(3UF7100*, 3UF7101*, 3UF7102*,
3UF7110.0-0, 3UF7111.0-0, 3UF7112.0-0)
Current setting Is = 20 A to 200 A Snap-on mounting onto 35-mm standard mounting rails, screw attachment onto
(3UF7103*, 3UF7113.0-0) the mounting plate or direct mounting onto the contactor
Current setting Is = 63 A to 630 A Screw attachment to the mounting plate or direct mounting onto the contactor
(3UF7104*, 3UF7114.0-0)
System interface for main circuit For connection to a basic unit or decoupling module
Current setting Is 3UF7100*0-0, 3UF7110*0-0: 0.3 A - ´3 A 3UF7103*0-0,
3UF7101*0-0, 3UF7111*0-0: 2.4 A - 25 A 3UF7113*0-0: 20 A to 200 A
3UF7102*0-0, 3UF7112*0-0: 10 A - 3UF7104*0-0,
100 A 3UF7114*0-0: 63 A to 630 A
Rated insulation voltage Ui (at pollution de‐ 690 V 1)
gree 3)
Rated operating voltage Ue 690 V
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp 6 kV 2)
Rated frequency 50/60 Hz
Type of current Three-phase
Short circuit Additional short-circuit protection is required in the main circuit 3)
Operating range 0.1 x Iu ≤ Is ≤ 10 x Io
Accuracy of current measuring (ranging ± 3% (typically)
from 1 x minimum current setting Iu to 8 x
maximum current setting Io)
Typical voltage measuring range
SIMOCODE pro
314 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.5 Technical data of the current measuring modules and the current / voltage measuring modules
Technical data of the current measuring modules or the 1st generation current / voltage measuring modules
Line-to-line voltage / voltage between lines 110 V - 690 V (depending on the setting, either the line-to-line voltage/phase-to-
(e.g.: UL1L2) ground voltage or the phase voltage is displayed)
Phase voltage (e.g.: UL1) 65 V to 400 V
Voltage measuring accuracy in the range ± 3% (typically)
from 230 V to 400 V
Accuracy of cos phi measurement (in the ± 5% (typically)
nominal load range cos phi = 0.4 to 0.8)
Accuracy of apparent power measurement ± 5% (typically)
(in the nominal load range)
Notes on voltage measurement
Current / voltage measuring modules must be Caution
used with a decoupling module in certain Note that the supply cables for voltage measurement may require additional
types of power system. See the table in Chap‐ cable protection.
ter Decoupling module (DCM) for 1st genera‐
tion current/voltage measuring modules (e.g.
3UF711.1AA00-0) (Page 126).
Feed-through opening Diameter Design of cable insulation
Current setting 0.3 A to 3 A; 2.4 A to 25 A 7.5 mm 6 kV according to IEC 60947-1
Current setting 10 A to 100 A: 14.0 mm 6 kV according to IEC 60947-1
Current setting 20 A to 200 A: 25.0 mm UM: 6 kV, IM: 8 kV according to
IEC 60947-1
Bus connection
Current setting Is 20 A to 200 A 63 A to 630 A
Connection screw M8x25 M10x30
Tightening torque 10 Nm to 14 Nm 14 Nm to 24 Nm
Solid with cable lug 16 mm - 95 mm
2 2) 4) 5)
50 mm2 - 240 mm 2) 4) 6)
Stranded with cable lug 25 mm - 120 mm
2 2) 4) 5)
70 mm2 - 240 mm 2) 4) 6)
AWG cable 6 kcmil to 300 kcmil 1/0 kcmil to 500 kcmil
Connection for voltage measurement
• Tightening torque TORQUE: 7 lb.in - 10.3 lb.in
0.8 Nm to 1.2 Nm
• Connection cross sections
- Solid 1 x 0.5 mm2 - 4 mm2 / 1 x AWG 20 to 12
2 x 0.5 mm2 - 2.5 mm2 / 2 x AWG 20 to 14
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 315
Technical specifications
15.6 Technical data of the decoupling module
Technical data of the current measuring modules or the 1st generation current / voltage measuring modules
- Finely stranded with end sleeve 1 x 0.5 mm2 - 2.5 mm2 / 1 x AWG 20 to 14
2 x 0.5 mm2 - 1.5 mm2 / 2 x AWG 20 to 16
1) for 3UF7103 or 3UF7104 to 1000 V
2) for 3UF7103 or 3UF7104 to 8 kV
3) You will find more information at SIMOCODE pro (https://www.siemens.com/simocode) and in Chapter Short-circuit pro‐
tection with fuses for motor feeders for short-circuit currents up to 100 kA and 690 V for 1st generation current / voltage
measuring module (Page 331)
4) Screw connection is possible with an appropriate 3RT19 box terminal.
5) When connecting cable lugs complying with DIN 46235 to cables with a cross section larger than 95 mm2, the 3RT19 56-4EA1
terminal cover is required to maintain phase separation.
6) When connecting cable lugs complying with DIN 46234 to cables with a cross section larger than 240 mm2 and when
connecting cable lugs complying with DIN 46235 to cables with a cross section larger than 185 mm2, the 3RT19 56-4EA1
terminal cover is required to maintain phase separation.
7) Valid for float values
8) A current range of 0.4 - 8 A is necessary for the 3UF7110-1AA01-0 version
SIMOCODE pro
316 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 317
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
15.7.2 Technical data, digital modules DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe
Technical data of the DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe digital modules
Mounting Snap-mounted onto 35-mm standard mounting rail or screw-mounted using additional
push-in lugs
Enclosure width 45 mm
System interfaces For connecting to a basic unit, an additional expansion module, a current measuring
module or a current / voltage measuring module or the operator panel
Rated control supply volt‐ • 24 V DC
age Us (according to • 110 V to 240 V AC/DC, 50/60 Hz
DIN EN 61131-2)
Operating range • 24 V DC: 0.8 to 1.2 x Us
• 110 V to 240 V AC/DC: 0.85 to 1.1 x Us
Power consumption DM-F LOCAL:
• 24 V DC: 3 W
• 110 V to 240 V AC/DC: 9.5 VA/4.5 W
DM-F PROFIsafe:
• 24 V DC: 4 W
• 110 V to 240 V AC/DC: 11.0 VA/5.5 W
Protective separation according Between relay enabling circuits / relay outputs and electronics
to IEC 60947-1
Rated insulation voltage Ui 300 V (at pollution degree 3)
Rated impulse withstand volt‐ 4 kV
age Uimp
Mains buffering time • 24 V DC: typically 20 ms at 0.8 x Us
• 110 V to 240 V AC/DC: typically 20 ms at 0.85 x Us, typically 200 ms at 230 V
Relay outputs 2 monostable relay outputs
• Number • Common potential connection is internally disconnected in a fail-safe manner by a
relay enabling circuit
• Function • Normally open contact, freely assignable to the control functions
SIMOCODE pro
318 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
Technical data of the DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe digital modules
Electrical service life of relay out‐ 0.1 million switching cycles (AC-15, 230 V/3 A)
puts
Relay enabling circuits
• Number 2 common switching-type, fail-safe relay enabling circuits
• Function Fail-safe normally open contacts
• Stipulated short-circuit protec‐ Fuse links operating class gL/gG 4 A (IEC 60947-5-1), separate for each relay enabling
tion for relay enabling cir‐ circuit
cuits / relay outputs
• Rated uninterrupted current of 5A
relay enabling circuits
• Rated switching capacity of re‐ AC-15: 3 A / AC 24 V; 3 A / AC 120 V; 1.5 A / AC 230 V
lay enabling circuits DC-13: 4 A / DC 24 V; 0.55 A / DC 60 V; 0.22 A / DC 125 V; 0.11 A / DC 250 V
• Electrical service life of relay en‐ 0.1 million switching cycles (AC-15, 240 V/ 2 A)
abling circuits
• Switching rate of the relay ena‐ 2000/h
bling circuits
Connection Removable terminals with screw connection
• Tightening torque TORQUE: 7 LB.IN to 10.3 LB.IN 0.8 Nm - 1.2 Nm
• Connection cross sections
- Solid 2x 0.5 mm2 to 2.5 mm2 / 1x 0.5 mm2 to 4 mm2
2x AWG 20 to 14 / 1x AWG 20 to 12
- Finely stranded with end sleeve 2x 0.5 mm2 to 1.5 mm2 / 1x 0.5 mm2 to 2.5 mm2
2x AWG 20 to 16 / 1x AWG 20 to 14
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 319
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
320 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 321
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
15.7.5 Safety-related technical data of the digital modules DM-F Local and DM-F
PROFIsafe
See "Technical Data" in the Manual "SIMOCODE pro Safety" fail-safe digital modules (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/50564852).
SIMOCODE pro
322 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 323
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
SIMOCODE pro
324 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.7 Technical data of the expansion modules
Connection
Tightening torque TORQUE: 7 LB.IN to 10.3 LB.IN 0.8 Nm to 1.2 Nm
Connection cross sec‐
tions
• Solid 2x 0.5 mm2 to 2.5 mm2 / 1x 0.5 mm2 to 4 mm2
2x AWG 20 to 14 / 1x AWG 20 to 12
• Finely stranded with 2x 0.5 mm2 to 1.5 mm2 / 1x 0.5 mm2 to 2.5 mm2
end sleeve 2x AWG 20 to 16 / 1x AWG 20 to 14
1) Technical data residual current transformer 3UL23: See Manual 3UG4/3RR2 Monitoring Relay
(https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/54397927).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 325
Technical specifications
15.8 Technical data of the multifunction module
SIMOCODE pro
326 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.8 Technical data of the multifunction module
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 327
Technical specifications
15.9 Technical data of the operator panels
SIMOCODE pro
328 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.9 Technical data of the operator panels
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 329
Technical specifications
15.10 Technical data of the compartment identification
Note
Product version of the operator panel with display
• For use with the SIMOCODE pro V PN/pro V EIP basic units, an operator panel with display
version *E07* or higher is required
• For use with the SIMOCODE pro V MB basic unit, an operator panel with display
version *E09* or higher is required.
Note
Usage restrictions concerning the operator panel with display
• SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit: The operator panel with display can only be used with
SIMOCODE pro V PB basic unit from version *E03*.
• SIMOCODE pro V PN, pro V EIP basic unit: An operator panel with display from version *E07*
is required for use with these basic units.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro PN basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• In combination with the SIMOCODE pro MR basic unit, version *E09* or higher is required
when using the operator panel with the 3UF7210-1AA00-0 display.
• When using the "Dry-running protection" function, the following operator panels with
display are necessary:
– 3UF7210-1AA00-0: ≥ E12
– 3UF7210-1AA01-0: ≥ E03
– 3UF7210-1BA00-0: ≥ E04
– 3UF7210-1BA01-0: ≥ E03
SIMOCODE pro
330 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.12 Typical reaction times
15.11 Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders for short-
circuit currents up to 100 kA and 690 V for 1st generation current /
voltage measuring module
Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders for short-circuit currents up to 100 kA and
690 V
You will find selection tables for fuseless and fused motor feeders in the following manuals:
• Configuration Manual Load Feeders – Configuring the SIRIUS Modular System (https://
support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/39714188)
• Configuration Manual Configuring SIRIUS Innovations UL - Selection Data for Fuseless and
Fused Load Feeders (https://support.automation.siemens.com/WW/view/en/53433538)
The manufacturer's declarations can be found in the Industry Online Support:
Declarations, manufacturer (https://support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/view/
109741638)
15.12.1 Typical reaction times of the SIMOCODE pro C/V device series
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 331
Technical specifications
15.12 Typical reaction times
1) Based upon a typical hardware set-up: Basic unit + current measuring module + 2 expansion
modules
Reaction time = inputs conversion time + internal processing time + outputs conversion time
Example:
You wish to switch a relay output of the basic unit via PROFIBUS when the "remote" bit is set:
• SIMOCODE pro C: Reaction time = 30 ms + 30 ms + 10 ms = 70 ms
• SIMOCODE pro V: Reaction time = 5 ms + 5 ms + 10 ms = 20 ms.
For the data from and to the PLC, you must also add the times for bus execution time, IM/CP
cycles, and PLC-CPU cycle.
You will find the corresponding information in the device descriptions.
2) 2nd generation current / voltage measuring modules
3) + set delay
4) Existing values are valid in compatibility mode
SIMOCODE pro
332 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.12 Typical reaction times
Table 15-3 Typical reaction times of the SIMOCODE pro device series
1) QE2 and QE3 must be parameterized to the outputs of the basic unit.
Example:
You wish to switch a relay output of the basic unit via PROFIBUS when the "remote" bit is set:
Reaction time = 30 ms + 30 ms + 10 ms = 70 ms
In the case of the data from and to the PLC, you must also add the times for bus runtime, IM/CP
cycles, and PLC-CPU cycle.
You will find the corresponding information in the device descriptions.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 333
Technical specifications
15.13 Technical data in Siemens Industry Online Support
1) Based upon a typical hardware set-up: Basic unit + current measuring module + 2 expansion
modules
Reaction time = inputs conversion time + internal processing time + outputs conversion time
Example:
You wish to switch a relay output of the basic unit via PROFIBUS when the "remote" bit is set:
Reaction time = 5 ms + 5 ms + 10 ms = 20 ms.
For the data from and to the PLC, you must also add the times for bus execution time, IM/CP
cycles, and PLC-CPU cycle.
You will find the corresponding information in the device descriptions.
SIMOCODE pro
334 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Technical specifications
15.13 Technical data in Siemens Industry Online Support
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 335
Technical specifications
15.13 Technical data in Siemens Industry Online Support
SIMOCODE pro
336 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
CAx data, dimension drawings 16
16.1 CAx data
You can find the CAx data in the Siemens Industry Online Support (https://
support.industry.siemens.com/cs/ww/en/).
1. Enter the full article number of the desired device in the "Product" field, and confirm with the
Enter key.
2. Click the "CAx data link.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 337
CAx data, dimension drawings
16.1 CAx data
SIMOCODE pro
338 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
List of abbreviations 17
Table 17-1 Guide to the abbreviations
Abbreviation Term
AM Analog module
AS Alarm switch
ATEX "Atmosphère explosible" according to ATEX Directive 2014/34/EU
AWG American Wire Gauge
Acycl. Acyclic
OP Operator panel
OPD Operator Panel with Display for SIMOCODE pro
BP Basic Performance
OPO Operational Protection Off
CPU Central Processing Unit
DCM Decoupling module
DHCP Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol
DIP Dual In-Line Package
DM Digital module
DM-F Fail-safe digital module (DM-FL or DM-FP)
DM-FL Digital Module Failsafe Local
DM-FP Digital Module Failsafe PROFIsafe
TO Torque open
TC Torque closed
DP Distributed peripherals
DRP Dry-running protection
DS Data record
DTM Device Type Manager
EEx European Norm EXplosion-proof: Specifies the protection classes for categorizing motors for
use in hazardous areas.
EIP EtherNet/IP
ex Explosion-proof
EM Ground-fault module
EMF Electromotive force
EMC Electromagnetic compatibility
F-CPU Fail-safe CPU (controller)
FMS Fieldbus Message Specification
BU Basic unit
BU0 SIMOCODE pro S basic unit
BU1 SIMOCODE pro C basic unit
BU2 1st generation SIMOCODE pro V PB (PROFIBUS) basic unit (for UM)
BU2+ 2nd generation SIMOCODE pro V PB (PROFIBUS) basic unit (for UM+)
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 339
List of abbreviations
Abbreviation Term
BU2_MR 1st generation SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU basic unit (for UM)
BU2_MR+ 2nd generation SIMOCODE pro V Modbus RTU basic unit (for UM+)
BU3 SIMOCODE pro V PN (PROFINET) basic unit
BU3 GP SIMOCODE pro V PN GP (PROFINET General Performance) basic unit
GP General Performance
GSD Device master data
HFT Hardware failure tolerance
HP High Performance
AUXS Auxiliary switch
I&M Identification and Maintenance
InM Initialization module
IT Isolation-Terre (isolation ground)
IM Current measuring module
MM Multifunction module
MR Modbus RTU
NTC Negative temperature coefficient (resistance dependent on temperature)
OB Organization block
OM Object Manager for PROFIBUS DP slaves for integration into STEP 7
OSSD Part of the electro-sensitive protective equipment (ESPE) that is connected to the machine
control system and that switches to the OFF state if the sensor part is tripped during operation
for the intended purpose.
PB PROFIBUS
PCS Process Control System
PDM Process Device Manager
PELV Protective Extra Low Voltage
PFD Probability of failure of demand: Probability of dangerous failure of a safety function on demand
PFDavg Average probability of failure of demand: Average probability of dangerous failure of a safety
function on demand
PFHD Probability of dangerous failure per hour: Average probability of hazardous failure occurring
each hour
PG Programming device
PL Performance Level
PCS Process Control System
PN PROFINET
PROFIBUS Process fieldbus
PTC Positive temperature coefficient (resistance dependent on temperature)
PZ Pozidriv
FB Feedback
FO Feedback open
TPF Test position feedback
FC Feedback closed
SELV Safety Extra Low Voltage
GF, CF Group fault or control function
SIL Safety Integrity Level
SIMOCODE pro
340 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
List of abbreviations
Abbreviation Term
SFB System function block
SFC System function
SFF Safe failure fraction
PLC Programmable logic controller
Th Thermistor
TM Temperature module
DRP Dry-running protection
TOFDT Total one fault delay time (maximum response time when error is present)
TWCDT Total worst case delay time (maximum response time in error-free state)
UKCA UK Conformity Assessed: British product designation, required for certain products that are
placed on the market in Great Britain (England, Wales and Scotland)
UKEX UK Type Examination certificate for products in potentially explosive atmospheres, issued by a
British notified body - British equivalent for ATEX, of the regulation governing equipment and
protective systems for intended for use in potentially explosive atmospheres from 2016 ("The
Equipment and Protective Systems Intended for Use in Potentially Explosive Atmospheres Reg‐
ulations 2016" (SI 2016:1107))
UM 1st generation current / voltage measuring module (identified in SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) as
IUM)
UM+ 2nd generation current / voltage measuring module (identified in SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) as
IUM V2)
TUL Useful lifetime
UM+_TL 2nd generation current / voltage measuring module for dry-running protection (identified in
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) as IUM V2 DRP)
UVO Undervoltage off
LC Local control
Cycl. Cyclic
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 341
List of abbreviations
SIMOCODE pro
342 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
0/4 to 20 mA monitoring
SIMOCODE pro supports two-phase monitoring of the analog signals of a transducer
(standardized 0/4 - 20 mA output signal). The analog signals are fed to the
"0/4 to 20 mA monitoring" function block via the analog module.
Addressing plug
The addressing plug is necessary to enable the hardware-based allocation of the PROFIBUS DP
address to a basic unit without a PC / PG.
ATEX
French abbreviation for "atmosphère explosible" (explosive atmosphere).
Synonym for the ATEX Directive 2014/34/EU.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 343
Glossary
Baud rate
The baud rate is the speed at which data is transferred and indicates the number of transmitted
bits per second (baud rate = bit rate). For example, with PROFIBUS DP, baud rates between
9.6 kbaud and 12 Mbaud are possible.
Bus
A common transmission path with which all stations are connected. It has two defined ends.
With PROFIBUS, the bus is a two-wire cable (copper cable) or a fiber optic cable.
Bus segment
PROFIBUS DP consists of at least one bus segment. A bus segment has at least two stations, one
of which must be a DP master. A maximum of 32 stations can be connected to a bus segment.
Cascading input
Safe, 1-channel input of a safety relay, e.g. DM-F LOCAL and DM-F PROFIsafe. Internally, this
input is evaluated like a sensor signal. If no voltage is present, the safety relay trips the enabling
circuits (outputs) in a safety-related way.
Class
Unit for the trip class. Indicates the maximum tripping time in which SIMOCODE must trip at a
current that is 7.2 times the value of the current setting Is in a cold state (motor protection
according to IEC 60947). If Class 10E is set for SIMOCODE pro, for example, it is ensured that the
(cold) motor will switch off after 10 seconds if a current occurs that is 7.2 times the current
setting. The trip class can be set to eight different settings ranging from Class 5E to Class 40E.
Class 1 master
Active station on PROFIBUS DP. It is characteristically used for cyclic data exchange with other
stations. Typical Class 1 masters include PLCs with a PROFIBUS DP connection.
SIMOCODE pro
344 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
Class 2 master
Optional station on PROFIBUS DP. Typical class 2 masters include:
• PC/PG with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)
• PDM (PCS7)
• PC with "SIMARIS manager" software (power management).
Connecting cable
Connecting cables are necessary for connecting the individual basic units with their current
measuring modules and, if required, with their expansion modules or operator panels. They are
available in various versions and lengths (ribbon cable 0.025 m, 0.1 m, 0.15 m, 0.3 m, 0.5 m;
round cable 0.5 m, 1.0 m, 2.5 m).
Notice
Maximum length of connecting cables:
The total length of all cables must not exceed 3 m on either of the system interfaces of the basic
unit!
Contactor
Electromagnetically operated low-voltage switch with only one position of rest; it cannot be
manually operated. Contactors can energize, carry, and deenergize currents in a circuit under
normal operating conditions, including operational overload. The contact system consists of
main and auxiliary contacts (NC, NO). Depending on the size of the contactor, the main contacts
can switch several hundred amps while the auxiliary contacts are only rated for control currents
of a few amps.
Control functions
Control functions (e.g. direct-on-line starters, reversing starters) are used for controlling load
feeders. They are characterized by the following important features:
• Monitoring the switch-on / switch-off process (no current flows in the main circuit without
the ON command)
• Monitoring the OFF state (no current flows in the main circuit without the ON command)
• Monitoring the ON status
• Tripping if a fault occurs.
Control stations
Control stations are places from which control commands are issued to the motor. The "Control
Stations" function block is used for administration, switching and prioritization of these
different control stations. SIMOCODE pro allows parallel administration of up to four different
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 345
Glossary
control stations. Dependent on the control function, up to 5 different control commands can be
transmitted from every control station to SIMOCODE pro.
• Local control, in the direct vicinity of the motor. Control commands via pushbuttons.
• PLC/PCS, switching commands are issued by the automation system (remote).
• PC, control commands are issued via an operator control and monitoring station or via
PROFIBUS DPV1 with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal).
• Operator panel / operator panel with display, control commands are issued via the buttons of
the operator panel / operator panel with display in the switchgear cabinet door.
SIMOCODE pro
346 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
Decoupling module
A module for connection between a current/voltage measuring module and the basic unit at the
system interface when voltage and power measurements are implemented in non-grounded
networks.
Device name
Before an IO device can be addressed by an IO controller, it must have a device name because the
IP address is permanently assigned to the device name. In the case of PROFINET, this method was
chosen because names are easier to handle than complex IP addresses.
Assignment of a device name for a specific IO device is comparable to setting the PROFIBUS
address on a DP slave.
An IO device does not have a device name when it is delivered. It can only be addressed by an
IO controller once a device name has been assigned to it, e.g. for transmission of the
configuration data (including the IP address) during startup or for exchanging useful data in
cyclic operation.
DIP switch
Small switch used to make certain basic settings. The abbreviation stands for Dual In-line
Package, a device package with two parallel rows of electrical connection pins.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 347
Glossary
Door adapter
The door adaptor is necessary for making the system interface of a basic unit available at an
easily accessible location (e.g. front panel), thus enabling fast parameterization.
DP master
A master that works with the DP protocol according to the EN 50170 standard, Volume 2,
PROFIBUS. Cyclic send data is exchanged between the DP master and the DP slave once in every
DP cycle. The DP master sends the cyclic receive data to SIMOCODE pro. In response,
SIMOCODE pro sends the cyclic send data to the DP master.
Emergency start
Emergency start deletes the thermal memory from SIMOCODE pro each time it is activated. This
allows the motor to be immediately restarted after an overload trip. This function can be used
to:
• Enable an immediate restart/reset after an overload trip
• Influence the thermal memory (motor model) during operation, if required.
Since the emergency start is edge-triggered, this function cannot permanently affect the
thermal motor model.
EMERGENCY STOP
Shutdown in case of an emergency according to EN 418 (ISO 13850).
An action in an emergency that is intended to stop a process or motion that would result in a
hazard.
SIMOCODE pro
348 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
Enabling circuit
An enabling circuit is used to generate a safety-related output signal. From an external
viewpoint, enabling circuits act as NO contacts (however, in terms of functionality, safety-
related opening is always the most important aspect). A single enabling circuit, that is internally
redundantly configured in the safety relay (two-channel) can be used for Category 3/4 according
to EN 954‑1 (ISO 13849-1).
EtherNet/IP
EtherNet/IP (EtherNet Industrial Protocol, often simply called EIP) is a real-time Ethernet that is
used mainly in automation engineering. EtherNet/IP was developed by Allen-Bradley (belongs
to Rockwell Automation) and was later handed over to the Open DeviceNet Vendor
Association (ODVA) as an open standard. In 1998, a working group of ControlNet International
designed a process for basing the already-published application protocol, Common Industrial
Protocol, on Ethernet. Based on this process, EtherNet/IP was published as an open industrial
standard in March 2000. ControlNet International (CI), the Open DeviceNet Vendor Association
(ODVA) and the Industrial Ethernet Association (IEA) were involved.
Besides PROFINET and Modbus/TCP, EtherNet/IP is an Ethernet-based fieldbus that is currently
widely spread.
Expansion modules
Expansion modules are intended as optional additions for the basic units. The following
expansion modules are available:
• Digital module (DM)
• Analog module (AM)
• Ground-fault module (EM, EM+)
• Temperature module (TM)
• Multifunction module (MM).
All expansion modules are equipped with 2 system interfaces (incoming/outgoing) and
removable terminals.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 349
Glossary
F_WD_Time
Monitoring time in the fail-safe PROFIsafe option. A valid, current safety message frame must be
received from the F-CPU within this monitoring time. Otherwise, the PROFIsafe option goes to
the safe state.
Factory settings
The factory settings are used to reset all parameters of a device to the default settings to which
they were set at the factory. The factory settings can be restored using either the "TEST / RESET"
button on the basic unit or via SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal).
Feedback circuit
A feedback circuit is used to monitor controlled actuators (e.g., relays or contactors with
positively driven contacts). The evaluation unit can only be activated if the feedback circuit is
closed.
Note:
The NC contacts of the relays to be monitored are connected in series and integrated into the
feedback circuit of the safety relay. If a contact in the enabling current path is welded, the safety
relay can no longer be activated because the feedback circuit remains in the open position.
Field/field level
The field or field level of an automation system contains the individual sensors and actuators, as
opposed to the control level, which is located above it in the hierarchy.
Fieldbus
Industrial communication system that connects a large number of field devices such as probes
(sensors), actuators and drives to a control device.
Function block
Defined group of functions that can be freely parameterized by the user and connected to other
function blocks to create a complete feeder-specific logic system. This means conventional wired
control circuits containing auxiliary relays, time relays, etc. can be completely replaced.
SIMOCODE pro
350 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
ground-fault monitoring function which is supported by both device series, SIMOCODE pro can
be extended by an additional and more precise external ground-fault monitoring system.
Ground-fault monitoring
SIMOCODE pro acquires and monitors all three phase currents. By evaluating the summation
current of the three current values, the motor feeder can be monitored for a possible residual
current or ground fault. There is a difference between internal and external ground-fault
monitoring:
Internal ground-fault monitoring:
Internal ground-fault monitoring via current measuring modules or current/voltage measuring
modules is only possible for motors with a 3-phase connection in power systems that are either
grounded solidly or with low impedance. The basic unit uses the total current to detect a
possible residual current / ground-fault current.
External ground-fault monitoring:
The external ground-fault monitoring using residual current transformer and ground-fault
module is normally used for power systems that are grounded with high impedance, or in cases,
in which precise detection of the ground-fault current is necessary, for example, for condition
monitoring. The ground-fault module (EM) or the multifunction module (MM) evaluates rated
fault currents using an externally connected summation current transformer (e.g. 3UL23).
GSD file
The properties of a PROFINET device are described in a GSD (General Station Description) file that
contains all the necessary information for configuration. You can use a GSD file to integrate a
PROFINET device in exactly the same way as a PROFIBUS device into an automation system
(SIMATIC S7 environment or any DP standard master system).
In the case of PROFINET IO, the GSD file is in XML format. The structure of the GSD file conforms
to ISO 15734, the worldwide standard for device descriptions.
I&M data
Identification and maintenance data.
Information stored in a module that helps you to check the plant configuration, to locate
hardware modifications in a plant, or to remedy faults in a plant. I&M data can be used to identify
modules uniquely on the network.
I/O
The term I/O devices is used in automation engineering to refer to peripheral devices, for
example, devices that are connected to centralized controls.
Independent operation
SIMOCODE pro protects and controls the motor feeder, independently of the automation
system. Even if the automation system (PLC) fails, or if communication is disrupted, the motor
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 351
Glossary
feeder remains fully protected and controllable. SIMOCODE pro can be used without being
connected to the communication bus. This can easily be connected later, if required.
Initialization module
Memory module permanently installed in the switchboard or the motor control center in which
the device parameters of intelligent switching devices are stored.
The initialization module is used in motor control centers with a withdrawable design in which
all functions concerning the motor feeder are fitted in an exchangeable withdrawable module.
The initialization module can be permanently installed in the switchboard and enables backup
of all parameters of a system and completely automatic transmission to a new system, e.g.
device replacement.
IP address
To enable a PROFINET device to be addressed as a node on Industrial Ethernet, this device also
requires an IP address that is unique within the network. The IP address is made up of 4 decimal
numbers with a range of values from 0 through 255. The decimal numbers are separated by a
decimal point.
The IP address is made up of
• The address of the (sub)net and
• The address of the node (generally called the host or network node)
IT system
The IT system (FR Isolé Terre) is a specific type of ground connection for increased fail-safe
protection in case of insulation faults.
Logic modules
Logical operations, time relay functions and counter functions are implemented using logic
modules.
Low voltage
All voltage levels used for the distribution of electricity that are within a range whose upper limit
in AC systems is generally 1000 V.
MAC address
Each PROFINET device is assigned a globally unique device identification at the factory. This 6-
byte-long device identifier is the MAC address.
SIMOCODE pro
352 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
Master
PROFIBUS DP is based on a master-slave architecture. Telegrams are sent by the master to the
addressed station (slave) and responded to by the slave.
Media redundancy
SIMOCODE pro V PN supports media redundancy according to the Media Redundancy Protocol
(MRP). This function is configured using the configuration tool of the automation system, e.g.
HW Config with STEP 7.
Memory module
The memory module is plugged into the system interface and is used for fast reading in or out
of the entire SIMOCODE pro parameterization, e.g. if a unit is exchanged.
Note
The SIMOCODE pro C and SIMOCODE pro V PB basic units up to product version *E08* only
support the 3UF7900-0AA00-0 memory module. The basic units SIMOCODE pro S and
SIMOCODE pro V (PB as from product version *E09*) also support the memory module
3UF7910-0AA00-0.
Modbus RTU
Modbus RTU (Remote Terminal Unit) is a standard protocol for network communication and uses
the electrical RS485 connection for serial data transmission between Modbus devices in the
network.
Modbus RTU uses a master/slave network in which the entire communication is triggered by only
one master device while the slaves can only respond to the request of the master. The master
sends a request to a slave address and only this slave address responds to the command
(exception: broadcast frames to slave address 0 which are not acknowledged by the slaves).
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 353
Glossary
Monitoring functions
The following monitoring functions
• Ground-fault monitoring
• Current limit monitoring
• Voltage monitoring
• Cos phi monitoring
• Active power monitoring
• 0/4 to 20 mA monitoring
• Operation monitoring
• Temperature monitoring (analog)
Operate "in the background" in the same way as motor protection and motor control. They can
be active or not, according to the control function selected.
Motor protection
The basic unit has several protection mechanisms for current-dependent motor protection:
• Overload protection
• Unbalance protection
• Stalled rotor protection
• Thermistor protection.
Multifunction module
Universal module of the SIMOCODE pro S device series with the following functions:
• Digital module function with four digital inputs and two monostable relay outputs
• Ground fault module function with the possibility of implementing powerful external
ground-fault monitoring in conjunction with the 3UL23 residual-current transformer
• Temperature module function with one input for connecting an analog PT100, PT1000,
KTY83, KTY84 or NTC temperature sensor.
SIMOCODE pro
354 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
Octet
Sequence of bytes. Octet n: string of n bytes.
Offset
A reference within an address table.
OPC UA client
An OPC UA client is a user program that accesses process data via the OPC UA interface. Access
to the process data is made possible by the OPC UA server.
OPC UA server
The OPC server provides the OPC client with a wide range of functions with which it can
communicate via industrial networks. SIMOCODE pro V PN provides extensive process data via
OPC UA.
Operation monitoring
SIMOCODE pro can monitor the operating hours and stop times of a motor and restrict the
number of startups in a defined time frame in order to avoid plant downtimes due to failed
motors caused by running or being stopped for too long.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 355
Glossary
Organization block
Organization blocks form the interface between the CPU operating system and the user
program. The order in which the user program is processed is specified in the organization
blocks.
Overload protection
SIMOCODE pro protects three-phase or AC motors in accordance with IEC 60947-4-1
requirements. The trip class can be set to eight different settings ranging from CLASS 5E to
CLASS 40E.
Pause time
The pause time is the specified time for the cooling down response of the motor when tripped
under normal operating conditions (not in the case of an overload trip). After this interval, the
thermal memory in SIMOCODE pro is erased and a new cold start is possible. This means that
many startups can be performed in a short space of time.
PC cable
The PC cable is used to connect the serial interface of the PC to the system interface of a basic
unit for device parameterization.
Note
PC cable variant
For SIMOCODE pro V PN, a serial PC cable 3UF7940-0AA00-0 as from product version *E02* or
a USB PC cable 3UF7941-0AA00-0 can be used.
PELV
Protective Extra-Low Voltage. Protective measure against electric shock (formerly referred to as
"protective extra low voltage with safe isolation").
SIMOCODE pro
356 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
In contrast to an SELV circuit, live parts and exposed conductive parts of the equipment may be
grounded and connected to the protective conductor. Safe isolation means that the primary
circuit of the transformer must be separated from the secondary circuit by double or reinforced
insulation. PELV is used whenever operational reasons dictate that live conductors of the low
voltage or bodies of the equipment must be grounded. This is the case, for instance, if
equipotential bonding is necessary to prevent sparking in containers or hazardous areas.
However, owing to the chassis ground, dangerous leakage currents can flow through the body
regardless of the low voltage if a fault occurs in the higher-level power system.
Use of power supply units according to IEC 60536, protection class III (SELV or PELV):
See Chapters "Safety-related tripping", "Fail-safe digital modules (DM-F)", and "DM-F Local and
DM-F PROFIsafe digital modules".
Pozidriv (PZ)
Type of fixing screws and cross-tip screwdrivers.
PROFIBUS
Process Fieldbus, a European process and fieldbus standard defined in the PROFIBUS standard
(EN 50170, Volume 2, PROFIBUS). It specifies the functional, electrical and mechanical
characteristics of a bit-serial fieldbus system.
PROFIBUS is a bus system that networks PROFIBUS-compatible automation systems and field
devices at the cell and field level. PROFIBUS is available with the DP (= Distributed Peripherals),
FMS (= Fieldbus Message Specification), PA (= Process Automation), or TF (= Technological
Functions) protocol.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 357
Glossary
PROFIBUS DP
PROFIBUS bus system with the DP (distributed I/Os - decentralized peripherals) protocol. The
main task of PROFIBUS DP is to manage the fast, cyclic data exchange between the central DP
devices and the I/O devices.
PROFIBUS DP interface
SIMOCODE pro has an integrated PROFIBUS DP interface (SUB-D socket or terminal connection
on the basic units).
PROFIBUS DPV1
Extension of the DP protocol. It enables acyclic data exchange of parameter, diagnostic, receive
and test data.
PROFIenergy
Profile for power management in production plants.
PROFIenergy uses the PROFINET communication protocol. It controls the power consumption of
automation equipment in production via a PROFINET network.
PROFINET
PROFINET (Process Field Network) is the open Industrial Ethernet Standard from Profibus &
Profinet International (PI) for automation.
Within the context of Totally Integrated Automation (TIA), PROFINET is the systematic
development of the following systems:
• PROFIBUS DP, the established fieldbus
• Industrial Ethernet, the communications bus for the cell level.
Experiences from both systems have been and are being integrated in PROFINET.
PROFINET IO controller
Device via which the connected IO devices are addressed. This means the IO controller
exchanges input and output signals with assigned field devices. The IO controller is often the
controller on which the automation program runs.
PROFINET IO device
Distributed field device assigned to one of the IO controllers.
SIMOCODE pro
358 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
PROFINET IO Supervisor
PG/PC for commissioning and diagnostics.
PROFIsafe
The PROFIBUS safety profile specifies communication between fail-safe I/O devices and fail-safe
controllers. It is based on the standards for safety-related applications as well as on the
experience of PLC users and manufacturers who are members of PROFIBUS International (PI).
The PROFIBUS safety profile has TÜV and BIA (Institute for Occupational Safety and Health of the
German Social Accident Insurance) certification. The newest version of the PROFIsafe
specification is the Profile for Safety Technology V1.11 specification, published in 07/2001.
Programming device
A compact and transportable PC, suitable for industrial purposes. Its distinguishing feature is the
special hardware and software for SIMATIC programmable logic controllers.
Protection functions
The protection functions
• Overload protection
• Unbalance protection
• Stalled rotor protection
• Thermistor protection
• Dry-running protection
operate alongside motor control "at a higher level in the background." They can be active or not,
according to the control function selected.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 359
Glossary
Record
Record.
RT communication
As a motor management system, SIMOCODE pro V PN does not have any time-critical
communication functions itself but it does support the PROFINET hardware RT used. The
integrated 2-port switch is therefore used to forward RT data.
SELV
Safety extra low voltage Low electric voltage that offers significant protection against electric
shock due to its low value and insulation. For certain requirements, the highest voltage must be
defined below 50 V AC or 120 V smoothed DC, especially if direct contact with live parts is
permissible. At a nominal voltage of 120 V, the greatest peak value in a smoothed DC system is
140 V, and at a nominal voltage of 60 V it is 70 C.
Use of power supply units according to IEC 60536, protection class III (SELV or PELV):
SFB
System function block A block integrated in the S7 CPU operating system that can be called like
a function block (FB) in the user program if required.
SFC
System function:
A function integrated in the S7 CPU operating system that can be called like a function (FC) in
the user program if required.
Shared device
Shared device is the function with which an IO device is used simultaneously by two or more IO
controllers.
Use of this function depends on whether the automation system supports the function. It is
configured using the configuration tool of the automation system, e.g. with STEP 7 HW Config.
SIMOCODE pro
360 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
The IEC standard defines four SIL levels SIL1 to SIL4, which are defined as the safety
implementations of electrical and electronic equipment. The SIL value describes the specified
safety function in the event of a fault.
SIMATIC
Name of products and systems for industrial automation from Siemens AG.
SIMATIC PDM
You can also configure SIMOCODE pro using the SIMATIC PDM (Process Device Manager)
software. The following options exist:
• SIMATIC PDM as a standalone program
• PDM integrated in STEP 7
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 361
Glossary
Slave
PROFIBUS DP is based on a master-slave architecture. Telegrams are sent by the master to the
addressed station (slave) and responded to by the slave.
Standard function
Standard functions are typical motor functions that can be activated according to need and, as
applicable, individually set for each motor feeder. They are already available, work
independently of the selected control function and can be used/activated as optional additions.
Station
A device that can send, receive or amplify data via the bus, e.g. master, slave.
Statistical data
SIMOCODE pro makes statistical data available, which can be read out, for example, with
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) under Commissioning → Service Data / Statistical Data.
STEP7
The basic STEP 7 software is the standard tool for the SIMATIC S7, SIMATIC C7, and
SIMATIC WinAC automation systems.
Stop category 0
Non-controlled shutdown by immediately switching off the power to the machine's drive
elements.
SIMOCODE pro
362 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Glossary
integrated into the process, can be monitored and are also available for a higher-level
automation system. You can, for example, implement analog temperature monitoring of the
motor windings, bearings, coolant or gearbox oil. SIMOCODE pro V supports various sensor
types (NTC, KTY83/84, PT100 and PT1000) for use with solid, liquid, or gaseous media.
Temperature monitoring
See temperature module (TM).
Terminal block
Insulating part comprised of one or more terminals, insulated from one another, for mounting
on a strip.
Thermistor protection
SIMOCODE pro V provides the option of connecting thermistor sensors (binary PTC) for
monitoring the motor temperature.
TN-C system
In a TN-C system (FR Terre Neutre Combiné) 1 wire is used simultaneously as a protective
earth (PE) and neutral wire (N).
TN-S system
In a TN-S system (FR Terre Neutre Séparé) the neutral wire and the protective earth are led
separately from the transformer up to the appliance.
Trip class
See "Class".
UKCA marking
UK Conformity Assessed: Product marking required in the United Kingdom for all Ex products
that are placed on the market in Great Britain (England, Wales and Scotland). It replaces the CE
marking. The CE marking is still required in Northern Ireland in addition to the UKCA marking.
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 363
Glossary
UKEX approval
UK Type Examination approval for products in potentially explosive atmospheres, issued by a
British notified body - British equivalent for ATEX, of the regulation governing equipment and
protective systems for intended for use in potentially explosive atmospheres from 2016 ("The
Equipment and Protective Systems Intended for Use in Potentially Explosive Atmospheres
Regulations 2016" (SI 2016:1107))
Unbalance protection
The extent of the phase unbalance can be monitored and transmitted to the control system. A
definable and delayable response can be triggered when an adjustable limit has been overshot.
If the phase unbalance is more than 50 %, the tripping time is also automatically reduced in
accordance with the overload characteristic since the heat generation of the motors increases
in asymmetrical conditions.
USB PC cable
The USB-PC cable is used to connect the USB interface of the PC to the system interface of a basic
unit for device parameterization.
Voltage monitoring
See monitoring voltage
Voltage monitoring
SIMOCODE pro supports two-phase undervoltage monitoring of either a three-phase network or
a one-phase network for freely selectable limits, direction of rotation (for AC) or readiness to
start. The response of SIMOCODE pro on reaching a prewarning level or trip level can be freely
parameterized and delayed. Voltage measurement is performed using current/voltage
measuring modules.
Y connecting cable
Connecting cable with which a connection can be made via the system interface from a
SIMOCODE pro basic unit to both an initialization module and a current measuring module.
SIMOCODE pro
364 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
AUXS, 340
AWG, 339
"
"Park position" for memory module, 78, 81
"SET/RESET" button DM-F Local, 320
B
"SET/RESET" button DM-F PROFIsafe, 322 Backing up and saving parameters, 255
"TEST/RESET" button, 75, 305, 309 Basic unit commissioning, 239, 249
"TEST/RESET" DM-F button, 131 Basic units, 20, 57
Baud rate, 247
Baud rate (detected), 247
0 Baud rates, 45
Box terminal blocks, 71
0/4-20 mA limits, 111
BP, 339
BU, 339
BU0, 339
3 BU1, 339
3UF50 compatibility mode, 45, 157 BU2, 339
BU2_MR, 340
BU2_MR+, 340
A BU2+, 339
BU3, 340
Accessories, 68
BU3 GP, 340
Active power limits, 111
Bus and controller monitoring on Modbus, 248
Active power monitoring, 35, 42
Bus connecting terminal, 71
Acycl., 339
Bus connection current measuring modules / current/
Acyclic services, 45
voltage measuring modules, 313, 315
Adapt display settings, 112
Bus connection system from 20 A to 630 A, 205, 207
Addressing plug, 69, 76, 154, 215, 221
Bus termination module, 71, 230
Alarm, fault, and system events, 269
Buttons of the operator panel, 329
Alarm, fault, and system events for compartment
Buttons of the operator panel with display, 329
identification, 149
Alarms according to DPV1, 45
AM, 339
Ambient conditions, 287
C
Analog module, 22, 64 Cabinet mounting, 305
Analog module (AM), 129, 132 Cable cross sections, 285
Analog module connection example, 197 Cable length (single) DM-F Local, 321
Analog module 1/2 open circuit, 269 Cable length (single) DM-F PROFIsafe, 322
Analog multiplexer, 49 Cable lengths of the sensor circuit cables, 284
Antivalence, 269 Calculation modules (calculators), 49
Application description Saving Energy with SIMATIC Catalog IC 10, 57
S7 and ET200 S, 11 Certificates, 11, 288, 301
Applications of SIMOCODE pro, 33 Characteristic curve of a type A sensor, 283
AS, 339 Circuit breaker, 36, 44
Assignment of the removable terminals, Circuit breaker control (MCCB), 75
SIMOCODE pro S basic units, 177 Clear initialization module data, 144
ATEX, 288, 301, 339 Clear memory module, 114
Autoactivation of compartment identification, 143 Color coding of connecting cable, 220
Automatic baud rate detection, 45 Color coding of the connecting cable, 222
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 365
Index
SIMOCODE pro
366 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 367
Index
Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by Fault memory, operator panel with display, 97
active power monitoring, 308, 311 Fault message, 10
Dry-running protection for centrifugal pumps by Fault - EM short-circuit, 275
means of active power monitoring, 35, 53, 289 Faults, 100
DS, 339 Faults, operator panel with display, 97
DTM, 339 Fault-tolerant S7-400H systems manual, 11
FB, 340
FC, 340
E F-CPU, 339
Feedback OFF, 274
EEx, 339
Feedback ON, 274
EIP, 339
Feed-through opening current measuring modules /
Electrical life of the relay outputs digital modules DM-
current/voltage measuring modules, 313, 315
F, 319
Firmware update, 264
EM, 339
Flashing, 49
EMC, 339
Flicker, 49
EMC stability according to IEC 60947-1, 304
FMS, 339
Emergency start, 48
FO, 340
EMF, 339
Frequencies, 304
End position, 272
Frequency, 119
Environmental conditions, 300
Frequency measurement, 123
Error buffer, 100
Full motor protection, 35
Ethernet connector, 227
Further information, 288
ETHERNET interface, basic unit, 309
EtherNet/IP, 47
Evaluation of the short-circuit detection of the sensor
cable, 284
G
Event memory, 100, 268 General performance units, 20
Event memory, operator panel with display, 97 GF, CF, 340
Example of a tripping characteristic with 3UF710* GP, 340
current/voltage measuring modules and Ground fault limits, 111
3UF711*-1AA00-0 1st generation current/voltage Ground-fault detection, 22
measuring modules, 282 Ground-fault module, 64
Exchanging a 3UF52 operator panel for a 3UF720 Ground-fault module (EM), 129, 133
operator panel, 261 Ground-fault module connection example, 193
Execution ON command, 269 Ground-fault module function multifunction
Execution STOP command, 269 module, 327
Expansion modules, 55, 129 Ground-fault monitoring, 35, 41
External fault, 48, 272 GSD, 340
External ground fault, 272
External ground-fault monitoring, 41
H
Hardware fault, 272
F HFT, 340
Factory settings, 115, 263 High Performance units, 20
Fail-safe digital module DM-F, 131 HP, 340
Fault - bus, 275
Fault - EM open circuit, 275
Fault - PLC/PCS, 275 I
Fault - temporary components, 275
I&M, 340
Fault antivalence, 275
Identification, 100
Fault end position, 275
SIMOCODE pro
368 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 369
Index
Maximum configuration with expansion modules Mounting current measuring modules / current/
when using an operator panel/operator panel with voltage measuring modules, 312, 314
display, a 2nd generation current/voltage measuring Mounting decoupling module, 316
module and a SIMOCODE pro V-PB basic unit with a Mounting digital modules, 317
product version earlier than Mounting digital modules DM-F, 318
E15 / SIMOCODE pro V Modbus basic unit with product Mounting lugs, 163, 167, 168
version E01, 136 Mounting of basic unit and multifunction module,
Measured curves, 35 SIMOCODE pro S, 165
Measured values display, 99, 103 Mounting of the basic unit, 309
Measured values, operator panel with display, 85 Mounting of the operator panel with display, 329
Measurement functions, 53 Mounting operator panels (OP), 170
Measuring current with an external current Mounting position, 304, 309
transformer (interposing transformer), 212 Mounting temperature module, 325
Memory module, 68, 76, 154, 215, 221 Mounting the current measuring modules, 167
Memory module cleared, 274 Mounting the initialization module in the
Memory module programmed, 275 switchboard, 145
Memory module read in, 274 Mounting the operator panel, 170, 328
Memory module type, 154 Mounting the operator panel adapter, 262
Memory module write protection off, 115 Mounting the operator panel with display, 171
Memory module write protection on, 115 Mounting, wiring, and interfaces of digital modules
Memory module write-protected, 275 DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe, 166
Messages, 100, 144 MR, 340
Messages, operator panel with display, 96 Multifunction module, 65
Modbus address, 247 Multifunction module (MM), 134
Modbus RTU, 45
Modification of selected device parameters via the
operator panel with display, 79 N
Module fault, 273
No start permitted, 273
Module supply voltage is not present, 273
Non-volatile elements, 49
Modules, 57
NTC, 340
Monitoring
PLC/PCS, 48
Monitoring additional process variables via the analog
module, 42
O
Monitoring any measured values using unrestricted OB, 340
limit monitors, 40, 43 OM, 340
Monitoring functions, 54 OP, 339
Monitoring operating hours, stop time, and number of OPC UA, 46
starts, 42 OPD, 339
Monitoring the number of starts, 35 Operating data, 36, 49
More information, 301 Operating hours monitoring, 35
Motor control, 35 Operating instructions, 11, 233
Motor control function, 74 Operating Instructions, 281, 292
Motor operating hours, 270 Operating instructions and further information, 11
Motor protection and motor control status, 105 Operation as DPV1 slave downstream from the Y-
Motor protection functions, 279 Link, 45
Motor stop time monitoring, 35 Operational Protection Off, 48
Motor temperature monitoring, 39 Operational Protection Off (OPO), 270
Mounting, 305 Operator controls and display elements, system
Mounting basic unit, expansion modules or the interfaces basic units, 75
decoupling module, SIMOCODE pro C/V, 164 Operator controls of the operator panel with
display, 83
SIMOCODE pro
370 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
Operator panel, 22, 60, 76 Pin assignments of the removable terminals of the
Operator panel adapter, 69, 155 1st generation current / voltage measuring
Operator panel with display, 22, 60, 79 modules, 211
Operator panel with display (OPD) timing chart, 84 Pin assignments of the removable terminals of the
OPO, 339 2nd generation current / voltage measuring
OSSD, 340 modules, 211
Outputs of the analog module, 323 PL, 340
Overload, 277 PLC, 341
Overload and unbalance, 277 PN, 340
Overload protection, 35, 39 Pole-changing reversing starter, 35
Overload relay, 35, 44, 75 Pole-changing starter, 35, 45, 75
Positioner, 36, 45
Positioner control, 75
P Power consumption, 307
Power consumption DM-F digital modules, 318
Parameter changes not allowed in the current
Power failure (UVO), 273
operating state, 274
Power failure backup time basic unit, 307
Parameter is incorrect ("Event" category), 274
Power failure back-up time digital modules DM-
Parameter settings in the "SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal)"
F, 318
software, 143
Power failure monitoring (UVO), 48
Parameterization methods, 234
Power supply to the digital module inputs, 189
Parameters, 99, 110
Power supply to the inputs of the basic unit, 181
Saving from basic unit to SIMOCODE ES file, 256
Preventive maintenance, 253
Saving from memory module to basic unit, 255
Prewarning overload, 277
Saving to the memory module, 255
Product Information System (ProdIS), 288, 301
Parameters, operator panel with display, 93
PROFIBUS, 340
PB, 340
PROFIBUS DP, 45
PC cable, 215
PROFIBUS DP connection, 226
PC cable for connecting a PC / PG, 221
PROFIBUS DP interface, 45, 306
PCS, 340
PROFIBUS DP services, 45
PELV, 340
PROFIBUS DP to a 9-way SUB-D socket, 226
Performance characteristics, 35
PROFIBUS User Organization (PNO) installation
Performance Level, 43, 131
guidelines, 230
Periodic tests of the device for control of ignition
PROFIBUS-Nutzerorganisation e. V., 231
sources, 300
PROFINET, 46
Permissible ambient temperature, 303
PROFINET installation guidelines, 231
Permissible number of starts exceeded, 278
PROFINET IO, 46
PFD, 340
Program memory module, 114
PFDavg, 340
Programming manual PROFINET IO - from PROFIBUS
PFHD, 340
DP to PROFINET IO, 11
PG, 340
Protection functions, 53
Phase failure protection, 35, 39
Protective separation acc. to IEC 60947-1 digital
Phase sequence, 119
modules, DM-F, 318
Phase sequence detection, 43
Protective separation according to IEC 60947-1, 304
Phase unbalance, 274
PTC, 340
Pin assignment for SIMOCODE pro V PN / EIP basic
Pulse width modulator, 49
units, 180
Push-in lugs for screw mounting, 70
Pin assignment for SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic
PZ, 340
unit, 178
Pin assignment of SIMOCODE pro C / pro V PB / pro V MR
basic units, 175
R
Rail mounting, 167, 168
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 371
Index
Rated control supply voltage Us, 307 Reversing starter, 35, 44, 75
Rated control supply voltage Us digital modules DM-
F, 318
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp, 307, 310 S
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp digital
Safety functions, 54
modules DM-F, 318
Safety guidelines, 220
Rated insulation voltage Ui, 307, 310
Safety Integrity Level, 43, 131
Rated insulation voltage Ui, digital modules DM-
Safety-related tripping, 43
F, 318
Safety-related tripping "Local", 48
Rated motor current, 281
Safety-related tripping "PROFIsafe", 45
Read and adapt main display, 101
Saving parameters from a SIMOCODE ES file into the
Read memory module, 114
basic unit, 256
Reading out statistical data, 253
Saving parameters onto the initialization
Reading out the device-internal error buffer, 116
module, 143
Reading out the device-internal event memory, 116
Screw mounting, 163, 167, 168
Relay enabling circuits digital modules DM-F, 319
Selection and ordering data, 57, 71
Relay outputs, 307
Selection tables for fuseless and fused motor
Basic unit, 310
feeders, 331
Relay outputs digital modules, 317
SELV, 340
Relay outputs DM-F digital modules, 318
Sensor circuit multifunction module, 327
Relay outputs multifunction module, 327
Sensor circuit of the temperature module, 325
Removable terminals, 210
Sensor circuit wiring, 284
Removable terminals for basic unit and multifunction
Sensor measuring circuits, 42
module, SIMOCODE pro S, 173
Sensor types, 134
Removable terminals for basic units, expansion
Sequence for connecting PROFIBUS DP to the basic
modules, or the decoupling module, SIMOCODE pro C/
unit, 226
V, 172
Sequence for mounting the bus terminal on the
Repair, 288, 301
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit, 165
Replacing a 1st generation current/voltage measuring
Sequence for wiring the removable terminals for
module with a 2nd generation current/voltage
SIMOCODE pro V PN / pro V EIP / pro V PN GP basic
measuring module, 260
units, 184
Replacing a 1st generation current/voltage measuring
Service and support, 288
module (UM) with a 2nd generation current/voltage
Service and Support, 301
measuring module (UM+), 260
Service data, 36, 50
Replacing a decoupling module, 258
Set time (= PC time), 115
Replacing a DM-F, 258
Setting IP parameters and device name on a plant-
Replacing the basic unit, 257
specific basis, 249
Replacing the current measuring module, 259
Setting IP parameters and EtherNet/IP device name
Replacing the current/voltage measuring
with SIMOCODE ES via PC cable, 250
module, 259
Setting IP parameters and PROFINET device name on a
Replacing the expansion modules, 258
plant-specific basis, 240
Required function is not supported, 272
Setting IP parameters and PROFINET device name with
Requirements for an interposing current
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal) via PC cable, 240
transformer, 212
Setting the DM-F DIP switches, 131
Reset, 48, 115
Setting the Modbus RTU address via addressing
Resetting, testing and parameterizing via
plug, 245
commands, 114
Setting the Modbus RTU address with
Residual current transformer, 22
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), 246
Response, 10
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via
Restart, 115
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), 237
Restoring the factory settings with the software
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via the addressing
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), 263
plug, 236
SIMOCODE pro
372 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
Setting the PROFIBUS DP address via Status - cooling down period active, 275
SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), 237 Status display, 99
Setting the PROFIsafe address on DM-F Status display for fieldbus communication, 107
PROFIsafe, 237, 242 Status DM-F enabling circuit, 275
Setting the rated motor current, 281 Status emergency start executed, 275
Setting the time with SIMOCODE ES (TIA Portal), 242 Status motor protection/motor control, operator panel
Setting the timer with SIMOCODE ES, 251 with display, 87
SFB, 341 Status test position (TPF), 275
SFC, 341 Stop time >, 275
SFF, 341 Storage clips for labeling strips, 81
Short-circuit protection according to IEC 60947-4-1, Stripped lengths, 174
type of coordination 2, 284 Support Request, 17
Short-circuit protection with fuses for motor feeders System interface
for short-circuit currents up to 100 kA and Connection of cables, 222
690 V, 331 Connection of system components, 222
Signal conditioning, 49 Operator panel, 221
SIL, 340 Operator panel with display, 221
SIMOCODE pro S basic unit, 74 System interface analog module, 322
SIMOCODE pro V High Performance basic unit, 75 System interface cover, 155, 216, 221
SIMOCODE pro C, 20, 57 System interface ground-fault module, 324
SIMOCODE pro C basic unit, 74 System interface main circuit current measuring
SIMOCODE pro S, 20, 57 modules / current/voltage measuring modules, 312,
SIMOCODE pro V EIP, 59 314
SIMOCODE pro V MR, 59 System interface multifunction module, 326
SIMOCODE pro V PB, 58 System interface temperature module, 325
SIMOCODE pro V PN, 59 System interfaces, 76, 215, 306
SIMOCODE pro V PN GP, 58 System interfaces decoupling module, 316
SIMOCODE pro V PN GP basic unit, 74 System interfaces digital modules, 317
SIMOCODEpro V PN GP, 20 System interfaces digital modules DM-F Local and DM-
Single-phase systems, 129 F PROFIsafe, 221
Snap-on mounting, 163 System interfaces DM-F digital modules, 318
Soft reversing starter, 36 System interfaces of basic unit, 309
Soft starter, 36, 45 System interfaces of the operator panel, 329
Soft starter with reversing contactor, 45 System interfaces of the operator panel with
Software, 71 display, 329
Software for configuring and commissioning, 244 System manual SIMATIC PROFINET System
Solenoid valve, 36, 45 Description, 11
Solenoid valve control, 75
Stalled positioner, 270
Stalled rotor, 270 T
Stalled rotor protection, 35, 39
TC, 339
Standard functions, 48
Technical data of the 2nd generation current / voltage
Standards, 303
measuring modules, 312, 313, 314
Star networks, 127
Technical data of the analog module, 322, 323
Star-delta reversing starter, 35, 44
Technical data of the current measuring modules or
Star-delta starter, 35, 44, 75
the 1st generation current / voltage measuring
Startup parameter block active, 269
modules, 314, 315, 316
States of the status LEDs / contactor controls during
Technical data of the decoupling module, 316
testing, 286
Technical data of the digital modules, 317, 318
Statistics/Maintenance, 99
Technical data of the DM-F Local digital module, 319,
Statistics/maintenance, operator panel with
320, 321
display, 88
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 373
Index
Technical data of the DM-F Local and DM-F PROFIsafe Test verification documents, 303
digital modules, 318, 319 Th, 341
Technical data of the DM-F PROFIsafe digital Thermistor motor protection, 35
module, 321, 322 Thermistor motor protection (PTC binary), 308
Technical data of the ground-fault module Thermistor motor protection with PTC (binary), 311
3UF7510-1AA00-0, 324, 325 Thermistor open circuit, 276
Technical data of the ground-fault Thermistor protection, 39
module 3UF7500-1AA00-0, 324 Thermistor short circuit, 276
Technical data of the initialization module, 150, 330 Thermistor trip level, 276
Technical data of the multifunction module, 326, 327, Third-party software components, 16
328 Through-hole connection up to 200 A, 205, 207
Technical data of the operator panel, 328, 329 Tightening torques, 174
Technical data of the operator panel with display, 329, Time stamping, 48
330 Time synchronization via PROFIBUS, 45
Technical data of the temperature module, 325, 326 Timers, 49
Technical data of the Y connecting cable, 150, 331 TM, 341
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro C / pro S / TO, 339
pro V PB / pro V MR basic units, 305, 306, 307, 308, TOFDT, 341
309 Touch current, 15
Technical specifications of the SIMOCODE pro V PN / TPF, 340
pro V PN GP / pro V EIP basic units, 309, 310, 311 Transformation ratio current transformer, 212
Temperature limits, 111 Trip class, 281
Temperature module, 42, 65 Trip level 0/4 - 20 mA < undershot, 270
Temperature module (TM), 134 Trip level 0/4 - 20 mA > overshot, 270
Temperature module connection example, 195 Trip level cos phi <, 269
Temperature module function multifunction Trip level I < undershot, 269
module, 327 Trip level I > overshot, 270
Temperature module 1/2 - trip level exceeded, 276 Trip level P < undershot, 270
Temperature module 1/2 - warning level Trip level P > overshot, 270
exceeded, 276 Trip level U < undershot, 270
Temperature module 1/2 out of range, 276 Tripping characteristic, 123, 281
Temperature module 1/2 sensor fault, 276 Tripping conditions of the Exe motor, selected:
Temperature monitoring, 35, 41, 134 CLASS 10E when using a 3UF710* current measuring
Temperature sensor, 22 module, 282
Terminal assignment for digital module DM-F Truth tables, 48
Local, 200 TUL, 341
Terminal assignment for digital module DM-F TWCDT, 341
PROFIsafe, 202 Type of ignition protection b, 289
Terminal assignment of the analog module, 196 Types of basic units, 73
Terminal assignment of the decoupling module, 198 Types of current measuring modules, 118
Terminal assignment of the digital module, 188 Types of protection EEx d, EEx e and EEx n, 279
Terminal assignment of the ground-fault Typical hardware configurations, 30
module, 192 Typical reaction times of SIMOCODE pro C, 331
Terminal assignment of the multifunction Typical reaction times of SIMOCODE pro S, 333
module, 190 Typical reaction times of SIMOCODE pro V, 332
Terminal assignment of the temperature
module, 194
Terminal covers, 70 U
Test, 48, 115
UKCA, 341
Test phases, 285
UKEX, 341
Test Position Feedback (TPF), 48, 274
UM, 341
Test trip, 276
UM+, 341
SIMOCODE pro
374 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006
Index
UM+_TL, 341
Unbalance protection, 35, 39
USB PC cable, 69, 153 Y
USB-to-serial adapter, 69, 153
Y connecting cable, 69
UVO, 341
V
Variants of current / voltage measuring modules, 119
Voltage limits, 110
Voltage monitoring, 35, 41, 119
W
Wait time, 248
Wait time (default value), 248
Warning level 0/4 - 20 mA < undershot, 278
Warning level 0/4 - 20 mA > overshot, 278
Warning level cos phi <, 277
Warning level I< undershot, 277
Warning level I> overshot, 277
Warning level P< undershot, 277
Warning level P> overshot, 277
Warning level U< undershot, 277
Warnings, 100
Warnings, operator panel with display, 96
Watchdog, 248
Watchdog (PLC/PCS Monitoring), 48
Watchdog time, 248
Web server, 46, 47
Win SIMOCODE-DP converter, 157
Wiring basic units, expansion modules, decoupling
module, 172
Wiring digital modules DM-F Local and DM-
F PROFIsafe, 199
Wiring of current / voltage measuring modules, 207
Wiring of current measuring modules, 205
Wiring sequence of the PROFIBUS cable for
SIMOCODE pro S basic units, 183
Wiring sequence of the removable terminal of the
SIMOCODE pro C/V basic units, 182
Wiring the initialization module, 145
Wiring the removable terminals of the expansion
modules and the decoupling module, 199
Working range DM-F digital modules, 318
Working range of basic unit, 307, 310
Wrong parameter, 273
Wrong password, 274
SIMOCODE pro
System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006 375
Index
SIMOCODE pro
376 System Manual, 10/2022, A5E40507475002A/RS-AF/006